[PowerPC] Rename TLS_TPRELGD to TLS_GDIE
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / bfd / elf32-ppc.c
1 /* PowerPC-specific support for 32-bit ELF
2 Copyright (C) 1994-2019 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 Written by Ian Lance Taylor, Cygnus Support.
4
5 This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
6
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program; if not, write to the
19 Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor,
20 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */
21
22
23 /* This file is based on a preliminary PowerPC ELF ABI. The
24 information may not match the final PowerPC ELF ABI. It includes
25 suggestions from the in-progress Embedded PowerPC ABI, and that
26 information may also not match. */
27
28 #include "sysdep.h"
29 #include <stdarg.h>
30 #include "bfd.h"
31 #include "bfdlink.h"
32 #include "libbfd.h"
33 #include "elf-bfd.h"
34 #include "elf/ppc.h"
35 #include "elf32-ppc.h"
36 #include "elf-vxworks.h"
37 #include "dwarf2.h"
38 #include "opcode/ppc.h"
39
40 typedef enum split16_format_type
41 {
42 split16a_type = 0,
43 split16d_type
44 }
45 split16_format_type;
46
47 /* RELA relocations are used here. */
48
49 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc
50 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
51 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc
52 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
53
54 /* Branch prediction bit for branch taken relocs. */
55 #define BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT 0x200000
56 /* Mask to set RA in memory instructions. */
57 #define RA_REGISTER_MASK 0x001f0000
58 /* Value to shift register by to insert RA. */
59 #define RA_REGISTER_SHIFT 16
60
61 /* The name of the dynamic interpreter. This is put in the .interp
62 section. */
63 #define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER "/usr/lib/ld.so.1"
64
65 /* For old-style PLT. */
66 /* The number of single-slot PLT entries (the rest use two slots). */
67 #define PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES 8192
68
69 /* For new-style .glink and .plt. */
70 #define GLINK_PLTRESOLVE 16*4
71 #define GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE(htab, h) \
72 ((4*4 \
73 + (h != NULL \
74 && h == htab->tls_get_addr \
75 && !htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt ? 8*4 : 0) \
76 + (1u << htab->params->plt_stub_align) - 1) \
77 & -(1u << htab->params->plt_stub_align))
78
79 /* VxWorks uses its own plt layout, filled in by the static linker. */
80
81 /* The standard VxWorks PLT entry. */
82 #define VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE 32
83 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_plt_entry
84 [VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
85 {
86 0x3d800000, /* lis r12,0 */
87 0x818c0000, /* lwz r12,0(r12) */
88 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
89 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
90 0x39600000, /* li r11,0 */
91 0x48000000, /* b 14 <.PLT0resolve+0x4> */
92 0x60000000, /* nop */
93 0x60000000, /* nop */
94 };
95 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt_entry
96 [VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
97 {
98 0x3d9e0000, /* addis r12,r30,0 */
99 0x818c0000, /* lwz r12,0(r12) */
100 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
101 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
102 0x39600000, /* li r11,0 */
103 0x48000000, /* b 14 <.PLT0resolve+0x4> 14: R_PPC_REL24 .PLTresolve */
104 0x60000000, /* nop */
105 0x60000000, /* nop */
106 };
107
108 /* The initial VxWorks PLT entry. */
109 #define VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE 32
110 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_plt0_entry
111 [VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
112 {
113 0x3d800000, /* lis r12,0 */
114 0x398c0000, /* addi r12,r12,0 */
115 0x800c0008, /* lwz r0,8(r12) */
116 0x7c0903a6, /* mtctr r0 */
117 0x818c0004, /* lwz r12,4(r12) */
118 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
119 0x60000000, /* nop */
120 0x60000000, /* nop */
121 };
122 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt0_entry
123 [VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
124 {
125 0x819e0008, /* lwz r12,8(r30) */
126 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
127 0x819e0004, /* lwz r12,4(r30) */
128 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
129 0x60000000, /* nop */
130 0x60000000, /* nop */
131 0x60000000, /* nop */
132 0x60000000, /* nop */
133 };
134
135 /* For executables, we have some additional relocations in
136 .rela.plt.unloaded, for the kernel loader. */
137
138 /* The number of non-JMP_SLOT relocations per PLT0 slot. */
139 #define VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS 3
140 /* The number of relocations in the PLTResolve slot. */
141 #define VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS 2
142 /* The number of relocations in the PLTResolve slot when creating
143 a shared library. */
144 #define VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS_SHLIB 0
145
146 /* Some instructions. */
147 #define ADDIS_11_11 0x3d6b0000
148 #define ADDIS_11_30 0x3d7e0000
149 #define ADDIS_12_12 0x3d8c0000
150 #define ADDI_11_11 0x396b0000
151 #define ADD_0_11_11 0x7c0b5a14
152 #define ADD_3_12_2 0x7c6c1214
153 #define ADD_11_0_11 0x7d605a14
154 #define B 0x48000000
155 #define BA 0x48000002
156 #define BCL_20_31 0x429f0005
157 #define BCTR 0x4e800420
158 #define BEQLR 0x4d820020
159 #define CMPWI_11_0 0x2c0b0000
160 #define LIS_11 0x3d600000
161 #define LIS_12 0x3d800000
162 #define LWZU_0_12 0x840c0000
163 #define LWZ_0_12 0x800c0000
164 #define LWZ_11_3 0x81630000
165 #define LWZ_11_11 0x816b0000
166 #define LWZ_11_30 0x817e0000
167 #define LWZ_12_3 0x81830000
168 #define LWZ_12_12 0x818c0000
169 #define MR_0_3 0x7c601b78
170 #define MR_3_0 0x7c030378
171 #define MFLR_0 0x7c0802a6
172 #define MFLR_12 0x7d8802a6
173 #define MTCTR_0 0x7c0903a6
174 #define MTCTR_11 0x7d6903a6
175 #define MTLR_0 0x7c0803a6
176 #define NOP 0x60000000
177 #define SUB_11_11_12 0x7d6c5850
178
179 /* Offset of tp and dtp pointers from start of TLS block. */
180 #define TP_OFFSET 0x7000
181 #define DTP_OFFSET 0x8000
182
183 /* The value of a defined global symbol. */
184 #define SYM_VAL(SYM) \
185 ((SYM)->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma \
186 + (SYM)->root.u.def.section->output_offset \
187 + (SYM)->root.u.def.value)
188 \f
189 /* Relocation HOWTO's. */
190 /* Like other ELF RELA targets that don't apply multiple
191 field-altering relocations to the same localation, src_mask is
192 always zero and pcrel_offset is the same as pc_relative.
193 PowerPC can always use a zero bitpos, even when the field is not at
194 the LSB. For example, a REL24 could use rightshift=2, bisize=24
195 and bitpos=2 which matches the ABI description, or as we do here,
196 rightshift=0, bitsize=26 and bitpos=0. */
197 #define HOW(type, size, bitsize, mask, rightshift, pc_relative, \
198 complain, special_func) \
199 HOWTO (type, rightshift, size, bitsize, pc_relative, 0, \
200 complain_overflow_ ## complain, special_func, \
201 #type, FALSE, 0, mask, pc_relative)
202
203 static reloc_howto_type *ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_max];
204
205 static reloc_howto_type ppc_elf_howto_raw[] = {
206 /* This reloc does nothing. */
207 HOW (R_PPC_NONE, 3, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
208 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
209
210 /* A standard 32 bit relocation. */
211 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
212 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
213
214 /* An absolute 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
215 FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them. */
216 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR24, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
217 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
218
219 /* A standard 16 bit relocation. */
220 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
221 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
222
223 /* A 16 bit relocation without overflow. */
224 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
225 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
226
227 /* The high order 16 bits of an address. */
228 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
229 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
230
231 /* The high order 16 bits of an address, plus 1 if the contents of
232 the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
233 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
234 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
235
236 /* An absolute 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
237 FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them. */
238 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
239 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
240
241 /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
242 indicate that the branch is expected to be taken. The lower two
243 bits must be zero. */
244 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
245 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
246
247 /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
248 indicate that the branch is not expected to be taken. The lower
249 two bits must be zero. */
250 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
251 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
252
253 /* A relative 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero. */
254 HOW (R_PPC_REL24, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
255 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
256
257 /* A relative 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero. */
258 HOW (R_PPC_REL14, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
259 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
260
261 /* A relative 16 bit branch. Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
262 the branch is expected to be taken. The lower two bits must be
263 zero. */
264 HOW (R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
265 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
266
267 /* A relative 16 bit branch. Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
268 the branch is not expected to be taken. The lower two bits must
269 be zero. */
270 HOW (R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
271 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
272
273 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16, but referring to the GOT table entry for the
274 symbol. */
275 HOW (R_PPC_GOT16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
276 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
277
278 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the GOT table entry for
279 the symbol. */
280 HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
281 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
282
283 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the GOT table entry for
284 the symbol. */
285 HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
286 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
287
288 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the GOT table entry for
289 the symbol. */
290 HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
291 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
292
293 /* Like R_PPC_REL24, but referring to the procedure linkage table
294 entry for the symbol. */
295 HOW (R_PPC_PLTREL24, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
296 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
297
298 /* This is used only by the dynamic linker. The symbol should exist
299 both in the object being run and in some shared library. The
300 dynamic linker copies the data addressed by the symbol from the
301 shared library into the object, because the object being
302 run has to have the data at some particular address. */
303 HOW (R_PPC_COPY, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
304 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
305
306 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR32, but used when setting global offset table
307 entries. */
308 HOW (R_PPC_GLOB_DAT, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
309 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
310
311 /* Marks a procedure linkage table entry for a symbol. */
312 HOW (R_PPC_JMP_SLOT, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
313 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
314
315 /* Used only by the dynamic linker. When the object is run, this
316 longword is set to the load address of the object, plus the
317 addend. */
318 HOW (R_PPC_RELATIVE, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
319 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
320
321 /* Like R_PPC_REL24, but uses the value of the symbol within the
322 object rather than the final value. Normally used for
323 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
324 HOW (R_PPC_LOCAL24PC, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
325 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
326
327 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR32, but may be unaligned. */
328 HOW (R_PPC_UADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
329 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
330
331 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16, but may be unaligned. */
332 HOW (R_PPC_UADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
333 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
334
335 /* 32-bit PC relative */
336 HOW (R_PPC_REL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, TRUE, dont,
337 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
338
339 /* 32-bit relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
340 FIXME: not supported. */
341 HOW (R_PPC_PLT32, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
342 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
343
344 /* 32-bit PC relative relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
345 FIXME: not supported. */
346 HOW (R_PPC_PLTREL32, 2, 32, 0, 0, TRUE, dont,
347 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
348
349 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the PLT table entry for
350 the symbol. */
351 HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
352 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
353
354 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the PLT table entry for
355 the symbol. */
356 HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
357 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
358
359 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the PLT table entry for
360 the symbol. */
361 HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
362 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
363
364 /* A sign-extended 16 bit value relative to _SDA_BASE_, for use with
365 small data items. */
366 HOW (R_PPC_SDAREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
367 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
368
369 /* 16-bit section relative relocation. */
370 HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
371 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
372
373 /* 16-bit lower half section relative relocation. */
374 HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
375 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
376
377 /* 16-bit upper half section relative relocation. */
378 HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
379 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
380
381 /* 16-bit upper half adjusted section relative relocation. */
382 HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
383 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
384
385 /* Marker relocs for TLS. */
386 HOW (R_PPC_TLS, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
387 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
388
389 HOW (R_PPC_TLSGD, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
390 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
391
392 HOW (R_PPC_TLSLD, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
393 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
394
395 /* Marker relocs on inline plt call instructions. */
396 HOW (R_PPC_PLTSEQ, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
397 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
398
399 HOW (R_PPC_PLTCALL, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
400 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
401
402 /* Computes the load module index of the load module that contains the
403 definition of its TLS sym. */
404 HOW (R_PPC_DTPMOD32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
405 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
406
407 /* Computes a dtv-relative displacement, the difference between the value
408 of sym+add and the base address of the thread-local storage block that
409 contains the definition of sym, minus 0x8000. */
410 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
411 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
412
413 /* A 16 bit dtprel reloc. */
414 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
415 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
416
417 /* Like DTPREL16, but no overflow. */
418 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
419 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
420
421 /* Like DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
422 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
423 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
424
425 /* Like DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
426 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
427 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
428
429 /* Computes a tp-relative displacement, the difference between the value of
430 sym+add and the value of the thread pointer (r13). */
431 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
432 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
433
434 /* A 16 bit tprel reloc. */
435 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
436 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
437
438 /* Like TPREL16, but no overflow. */
439 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
440 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
441
442 /* Like TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
443 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
444 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
445
446 /* Like TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
447 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
448 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
449
450 /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
451 with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes the offset
452 to the first entry. */
453 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
454 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
455
456 /* Like GOT_TLSGD16, but no overflow. */
457 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
458 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
459
460 /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
461 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
462 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
463
464 /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
465 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
466 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
467
468 /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
469 with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and zero, and computes the offset to the
470 first entry. */
471 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
472 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
473
474 /* Like GOT_TLSLD16, but no overflow. */
475 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
476 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
477
478 /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
479 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
480 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
481
482 /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
483 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
484 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
485
486 /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes
487 the offset to the entry. */
488 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
489 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
490
491 /* Like GOT_DTPREL16, but no overflow. */
492 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
493 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
494
495 /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
496 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
497 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
498
499 /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
500 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
501 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
502
503 /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@tprel, and computes the
504 offset to the entry. */
505 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
506 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
507
508 /* Like GOT_TPREL16, but no overflow. */
509 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
510 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
511
512 /* Like GOT_TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
513 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
514 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
515
516 /* Like GOT_TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
517 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
518 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
519
520 /* The remaining relocs are from the Embedded ELF ABI, and are not
521 in the SVR4 ELF ABI. */
522
523 /* 32 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */
524 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
525 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
526
527 /* 16 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */
528 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
529 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
530
531 /* 16 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */
532 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
533 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
534
535 /* The high order 16 bits of the addend minus the symbol. */
536 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
537 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
538
539 /* The high order 16 bits of the result of the addend minus the address,
540 plus 1 if the contents of the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number,
541 is negative. */
542 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
543 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
544
545 /* 16 bit value resulting from allocating a 4 byte word to hold an
546 address in the .sdata section, and returning the offset from
547 _SDA_BASE_ for that relocation. */
548 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
549 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
550
551 /* 16 bit value resulting from allocating a 4 byte word to hold an
552 address in the .sdata2 section, and returning the offset from
553 _SDA2_BASE_ for that relocation. */
554 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
555 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
556
557 /* A sign-extended 16 bit value relative to _SDA2_BASE_, for use with
558 small data items. */
559 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
560 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
561
562 /* Relocate against either _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_, filling in the 16 bit
563 signed offset from the appropriate base, and filling in the register
564 field with the appropriate register (0, 2, or 13). */
565 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA21, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
566 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
567
568 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF */
569 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16 */
570 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO */
571 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI */
572 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA */
573 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD */
574
575 /* PC relative relocation against either _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_, filling
576 in the 16 bit signed offset from the appropriate base, and filling in the
577 register field with the appropriate register (0, 2, or 13). */
578 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
579 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
580
581 /* A relative 8 bit branch. */
582 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL8, 1, 8, 0xff, 1, TRUE, signed,
583 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
584
585 /* A relative 15 bit branch. */
586 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL15, 2, 16, 0xfffe, 0, TRUE, signed,
587 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
588
589 /* A relative 24 bit branch. */
590 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL24, 2, 25, 0x1fffffe, 0, TRUE, signed,
591 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
592
593 /* The 16 LSBS in split16a format. */
594 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_LO16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
595 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
596
597 /* The 16 LSBS in split16d format. */
598 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_LO16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
599 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
600
601 /* Bits 16-31 split16a format. */
602 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HI16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
603 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
604
605 /* Bits 16-31 split16d format. */
606 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HI16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
607 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
608
609 /* Bits 16-31 (High Adjusted) in split16a format. */
610 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HA16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
611 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
612
613 /* Bits 16-31 (High Adjusted) in split16d format. */
614 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HA16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
615 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
616
617 /* This reloc is like R_PPC_EMB_SDA21 but only applies to e_add16i
618 instructions. If the register base is 0 then the linker changes
619 the e_add16i to an e_li instruction. */
620 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDA21, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
621 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
622
623 /* Like R_PPC_VLE_SDA21 but ignore overflow. */
624 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
625 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
626
627 /* The 16 LSBS relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16a format. */
628 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
629 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
630
631 /* The 16 LSBS relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16d format. */
632 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
633 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
634
635 /* Bits 16-31 relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16a format. */
636 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
637 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
638
639 /* Bits 16-31 relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16d format. */
640 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
641 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
642
643 /* Bits 16-31 (HA) relative to _SDA_BASE split16a format. */
644 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
645 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
646
647 /* Bits 16-31 (HA) relative to _SDA_BASE split16d format. */
648 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
649 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
650
651 /* e_li split20 format. */
652 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20, 2, 20, 0x1f7fff, 0, FALSE, dont,
653 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
654
655 HOW (R_PPC_IRELATIVE, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
656 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
657
658 /* A 16 bit relative relocation. */
659 HOW (R_PPC_REL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, TRUE, signed,
660 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
661
662 /* A 16 bit relative relocation without overflow. */
663 HOW (R_PPC_REL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, TRUE, dont,
664 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
665
666 /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address. */
667 HOW (R_PPC_REL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, dont,
668 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
669
670 /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address, plus 1 if the contents of
671 the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
672 HOW (R_PPC_REL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, dont,
673 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
674
675 /* Like R_PPC_REL16_HA but for split field in addpcis. */
676 HOW (R_PPC_REL16DX_HA, 2, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, TRUE, signed,
677 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
678
679 /* A split-field reloc for addpcis, non-relative (gas internal use only). */
680 HOW (R_PPC_16DX_HA, 2, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, FALSE, signed,
681 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
682
683 /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable hierarchy. */
684 HOW (R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
685 NULL),
686
687 /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable member usage. */
688 HOW (R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
689 NULL),
690
691 /* Phony reloc to handle AIX style TOC entries. */
692 HOW (R_PPC_TOC16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
693 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
694 };
695 \f
696 /* Initialize the ppc_elf_howto_table, so that linear accesses can be done. */
697
698 static void
699 ppc_elf_howto_init (void)
700 {
701 unsigned int i, type;
702
703 for (i = 0;
704 i < sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw) / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw[0]);
705 i++)
706 {
707 type = ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].type;
708 if (type >= (sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_table)
709 / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_table[0])))
710 abort ();
711 ppc_elf_howto_table[type] = &ppc_elf_howto_raw[i];
712 }
713 }
714
715 static reloc_howto_type *
716 ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
717 bfd_reloc_code_real_type code)
718 {
719 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r;
720
721 /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
722 if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
723 ppc_elf_howto_init ();
724
725 switch (code)
726 {
727 default:
728 return NULL;
729
730 case BFD_RELOC_NONE: r = R_PPC_NONE; break;
731 case BFD_RELOC_32: r = R_PPC_ADDR32; break;
732 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA26: r = R_PPC_ADDR24; break;
733 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
734 case BFD_RELOC_16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16; break;
735 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
736 case BFD_RELOC_LO16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_LO; break;
737 case BFD_RELOC_HI16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_HI; break;
738 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_HA; break;
739 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16: r = R_PPC_ADDR14; break;
740 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRTAKEN: r = R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN; break;
741 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRNTAKEN: r = R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN; break;
742 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B26: r = R_PPC_REL24; break;
743 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16: r = R_PPC_REL14; break;
744 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRTAKEN: r = R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN; break;
745 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRNTAKEN: r = R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN; break;
746 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_DS:
747 case BFD_RELOC_16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16; break;
748 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
749 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_LO; break;
750 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_HI; break;
751 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_HA; break;
752 case BFD_RELOC_24_PLT_PCREL: r = R_PPC_PLTREL24; break;
753 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_COPY: r = R_PPC_COPY; break;
754 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GLOB_DAT: r = R_PPC_GLOB_DAT; break;
755 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_LOCAL24PC: r = R_PPC_LOCAL24PC; break;
756 case BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL32; break;
757 case BFD_RELOC_32_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT32; break;
758 case BFD_RELOC_32_PLT_PCREL: r = R_PPC_PLTREL32; break;
759 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
760 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_LO; break;
761 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_HI; break;
762 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_HA; break;
763 case BFD_RELOC_GPREL16: r = R_PPC_SDAREL16; break;
764 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS:
765 case BFD_RELOC_16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF; break;
766 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS:
767 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO; break;
768 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI; break;
769 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA; break;
770 case BFD_RELOC_CTOR: r = R_PPC_ADDR32; break;
771 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
772 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TOC16: r = R_PPC_TOC16; break;
773 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLS: r = R_PPC_TLS; break;
774 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSGD: r = R_PPC_TLSGD; break;
775 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSLD: r = R_PPC_TLSLD; break;
776 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPMOD: r = R_PPC_DTPMOD32; break;
777 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
778 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16: r = R_PPC_TPREL16; break;
779 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
780 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO; break;
781 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_HI; break;
782 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA; break;
783 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL: r = R_PPC_TPREL32; break;
784 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS:
785 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16; break;
786 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
787 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO; break;
788 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI; break;
789 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA; break;
790 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL: r = R_PPC_DTPREL32; break;
791 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16; break;
792 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO; break;
793 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI; break;
794 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA; break;
795 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16; break;
796 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO; break;
797 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI; break;
798 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA; break;
799 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16; break;
800 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO; break;
801 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI; break;
802 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA; break;
803 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16; break;
804 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO; break;
805 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI; break;
806 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA; break;
807 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR32: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32; break;
808 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16; break;
809 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO; break;
810 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI; break;
811 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA; break;
812 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDAI16: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16; break;
813 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16; break;
814 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL; break;
815 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA21: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA21; break;
816 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_MRKREF: r = R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF; break;
817 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16; break;
818 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO; break;
819 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI; break;
820 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA; break;
821 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD: r = R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD; break;
822 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELSDA: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA; break;
823 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL8: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL8; break;
824 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL15: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL15; break;
825 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL24: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL24; break;
826 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_LO16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_LO16A; break;
827 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_LO16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_LO16D; break;
828 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HI16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_HI16A; break;
829 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HI16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_HI16D; break;
830 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HA16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_HA16A; break;
831 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HA16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_HA16D; break;
832 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDA21: r = R_PPC_VLE_SDA21; break;
833 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO: r = R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO; break;
834 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
835 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A;
836 break;
837 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
838 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D;
839 break;
840 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
841 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A;
842 break;
843 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
844 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D;
845 break;
846 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
847 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A;
848 break;
849 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
850 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D;
851 break;
852 case BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16; break;
853 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_LO; break;
854 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_HI; break;
855 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_HA; break;
856 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_16DX_HA: r = R_PPC_16DX_HA; break;
857 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_REL16DX_HA: r = R_PPC_REL16DX_HA; break;
858 case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_INHERIT: r = R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT; break;
859 case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY: r = R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY; break;
860 }
861
862 return ppc_elf_howto_table[r];
863 };
864
865 static reloc_howto_type *
866 ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
867 const char *r_name)
868 {
869 unsigned int i;
870
871 for (i = 0;
872 i < sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw) / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw[0]);
873 i++)
874 if (ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].name != NULL
875 && strcasecmp (ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].name, r_name) == 0)
876 return &ppc_elf_howto_raw[i];
877
878 return NULL;
879 }
880
881 /* Set the howto pointer for a PowerPC ELF reloc. */
882
883 static bfd_boolean
884 ppc_elf_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd,
885 arelent *cache_ptr,
886 Elf_Internal_Rela *dst)
887 {
888 unsigned int r_type;
889
890 /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
891 if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
892 ppc_elf_howto_init ();
893
894 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info);
895 if (r_type >= R_PPC_max)
896 {
897 /* xgettext:c-format */
898 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
899 abfd, r_type);
900 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
901 return FALSE;
902 }
903
904 cache_ptr->howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
905
906 /* Just because the above assert didn't trigger doesn't mean that
907 ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info) is necessarily a valid relocation. */
908 if (cache_ptr->howto == NULL)
909 {
910 /* xgettext:c-format */
911 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
912 abfd, r_type);
913 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
914
915 return FALSE;
916 }
917
918 return TRUE;
919 }
920
921 /* Handle the R_PPC_ADDR16_HA and R_PPC_REL16_HA relocs. */
922
923 static bfd_reloc_status_type
924 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc (bfd *abfd,
925 arelent *reloc_entry,
926 asymbol *symbol,
927 void *data,
928 asection *input_section,
929 bfd *output_bfd,
930 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
931 {
932 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
933 long insn;
934 bfd_size_type octets;
935 bfd_vma value;
936
937 if (output_bfd != NULL)
938 {
939 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
940 return bfd_reloc_ok;
941 }
942
943 reloc_entry->addend += 0x8000;
944 r_type = reloc_entry->howto->type;
945 if (r_type != R_PPC_REL16DX_HA)
946 return bfd_reloc_continue;
947
948 value = 0;
949 if (!bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
950 value = symbol->value;
951 value += (reloc_entry->addend
952 + symbol->section->output_offset
953 + symbol->section->output_section->vma);
954 value -= (reloc_entry->address
955 + input_section->output_offset
956 + input_section->output_section->vma);
957 value >>= 16;
958
959 octets = reloc_entry->address * bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd);
960 insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
961 insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
962 insn |= (value & 0xffc1) | ((value & 0x3e) << 15);
963 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
964 return bfd_reloc_ok;
965 }
966
967 static bfd_reloc_status_type
968 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc (bfd *abfd,
969 arelent *reloc_entry,
970 asymbol *symbol,
971 void *data,
972 asection *input_section,
973 bfd *output_bfd,
974 char **error_message)
975 {
976 /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
977 call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
978 link time. */
979 if (output_bfd != NULL)
980 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
981 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
982
983 if (error_message != NULL)
984 {
985 static char buf[60];
986 sprintf (buf, _("generic linker can't handle %s"),
987 reloc_entry->howto->name);
988 *error_message = buf;
989 }
990 return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
991 }
992 \f
993 /* Sections created by the linker. */
994
995 typedef struct elf_linker_section
996 {
997 /* Pointer to the bfd section. */
998 asection *section;
999 /* Section name. */
1000 const char *name;
1001 /* Associated bss section name. */
1002 const char *bss_name;
1003 /* Associated symbol name. */
1004 const char *sym_name;
1005 /* Associated symbol. */
1006 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sym;
1007 } elf_linker_section_t;
1008
1009 /* Linked list of allocated pointer entries. This hangs off of the
1010 symbol lists, and provides allows us to return different pointers,
1011 based on different addend's. */
1012
1013 typedef struct elf_linker_section_pointers
1014 {
1015 /* next allocated pointer for this symbol */
1016 struct elf_linker_section_pointers *next;
1017 /* offset of pointer from beginning of section */
1018 bfd_vma offset;
1019 /* addend used */
1020 bfd_vma addend;
1021 /* which linker section this is */
1022 elf_linker_section_t *lsect;
1023 } elf_linker_section_pointers_t;
1024
1025 struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata
1026 {
1027 struct elf_obj_tdata elf;
1028
1029 /* A mapping from local symbols to offsets into the various linker
1030 sections added. This is index by the symbol index. */
1031 elf_linker_section_pointers_t **linker_section_pointers;
1032
1033 /* Flags used to auto-detect plt type. */
1034 unsigned int makes_plt_call : 1;
1035 unsigned int has_rel16 : 1;
1036 };
1037
1038 #define ppc_elf_tdata(bfd) \
1039 ((struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata *) (bfd)->tdata.any)
1040
1041 #define elf_local_ptr_offsets(bfd) \
1042 (ppc_elf_tdata (bfd)->linker_section_pointers)
1043
1044 #define is_ppc_elf(bfd) \
1045 (bfd_get_flavour (bfd) == bfd_target_elf_flavour \
1046 && elf_object_id (bfd) == PPC32_ELF_DATA)
1047
1048 /* Override the generic function because we store some extras. */
1049
1050 static bfd_boolean
1051 ppc_elf_mkobject (bfd *abfd)
1052 {
1053 return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata),
1054 PPC32_ELF_DATA);
1055 }
1056
1057 /* When defaulting arch/mach, decode apuinfo to find a better match. */
1058
1059 bfd_boolean
1060 _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (bfd *abfd)
1061 {
1062 unsigned long mach = 0;
1063 asection *s;
1064 unsigned char *contents;
1065
1066 if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32
1067 && bfd_big_endian (abfd))
1068 {
1069
1070 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
1071 if ((elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1072 break;
1073 if (s != NULL)
1074 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_vle;
1075 }
1076
1077 if (mach == 0)
1078 {
1079 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1080 if (s != NULL
1081 && s->size >= 24
1082 && bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, s, &contents))
1083 {
1084 unsigned int apuinfo_size = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + 4);
1085 unsigned int i;
1086
1087 for (i = 20; i < apuinfo_size + 20 && i + 4 <= s->size; i += 4)
1088 {
1089 unsigned int val = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + i);
1090 switch (val >> 16)
1091 {
1092 case PPC_APUINFO_PMR:
1093 case PPC_APUINFO_RFMCI:
1094 if (mach == 0)
1095 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_titan;
1096 break;
1097
1098 case PPC_APUINFO_ISEL:
1099 case PPC_APUINFO_CACHELCK:
1100 if (mach == bfd_mach_ppc_titan)
1101 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_e500mc;
1102 break;
1103
1104 case PPC_APUINFO_SPE:
1105 case PPC_APUINFO_EFS:
1106 case PPC_APUINFO_BRLOCK:
1107 if (mach != bfd_mach_ppc_vle)
1108 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_e500;
1109 break;
1110
1111 case PPC_APUINFO_VLE:
1112 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_vle;
1113 break;
1114
1115 default:
1116 mach = -1ul;
1117 }
1118 }
1119 free (contents);
1120 }
1121 }
1122
1123 if (mach != 0 && mach != -1ul)
1124 {
1125 const bfd_arch_info_type *arch;
1126
1127 for (arch = abfd->arch_info->next; arch; arch = arch->next)
1128 if (arch->mach == mach)
1129 {
1130 abfd->arch_info = arch;
1131 break;
1132 }
1133 }
1134 return TRUE;
1135 }
1136
1137 /* Fix bad default arch selected for a 32 bit input bfd when the
1138 default is 64 bit. Also select arch based on apuinfo. */
1139
1140 static bfd_boolean
1141 ppc_elf_object_p (bfd *abfd)
1142 {
1143 if (!abfd->arch_info->the_default)
1144 return TRUE;
1145
1146 if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 64)
1147 {
1148 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
1149
1150 if (i_ehdr->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
1151 {
1152 /* Relies on arch after 64 bit default being 32 bit default. */
1153 abfd->arch_info = abfd->arch_info->next;
1154 BFD_ASSERT (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32);
1155 }
1156 }
1157 return _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (abfd);
1158 }
1159
1160 /* Function to set whether a module needs the -mrelocatable bit set. */
1161
1162 static bfd_boolean
1163 ppc_elf_set_private_flags (bfd *abfd, flagword flags)
1164 {
1165 BFD_ASSERT (!elf_flags_init (abfd)
1166 || elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags == flags);
1167
1168 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags = flags;
1169 elf_flags_init (abfd) = TRUE;
1170 return TRUE;
1171 }
1172
1173 /* Support for core dump NOTE sections. */
1174
1175 static bfd_boolean
1176 ppc_elf_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
1177 {
1178 int offset;
1179 unsigned int size;
1180
1181 switch (note->descsz)
1182 {
1183 default:
1184 return FALSE;
1185
1186 case 268: /* Linux/PPC. */
1187 /* pr_cursig */
1188 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_16 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
1189
1190 /* pr_pid */
1191 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 24);
1192
1193 /* pr_reg */
1194 offset = 72;
1195 size = 192;
1196
1197 break;
1198 }
1199
1200 /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
1201 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
1202 size, note->descpos + offset);
1203 }
1204
1205 static bfd_boolean
1206 ppc_elf_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
1207 {
1208 switch (note->descsz)
1209 {
1210 default:
1211 return FALSE;
1212
1213 case 128: /* Linux/PPC elf_prpsinfo. */
1214 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
1215 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 16);
1216 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
1217 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 32, 16);
1218 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
1219 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 48, 80);
1220 }
1221
1222 /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
1223 onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
1224 implementations, so strip it off if it exists. */
1225
1226 {
1227 char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command;
1228 int n = strlen (command);
1229
1230 if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
1231 command[n - 1] = '\0';
1232 }
1233
1234 return TRUE;
1235 }
1236
1237 static char *
1238 ppc_elf_write_core_note (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz, int note_type, ...)
1239 {
1240 switch (note_type)
1241 {
1242 default:
1243 return NULL;
1244
1245 case NT_PRPSINFO:
1246 {
1247 char data[128] ATTRIBUTE_NONSTRING;
1248 va_list ap;
1249
1250 va_start (ap, note_type);
1251 memset (data, 0, sizeof (data));
1252 strncpy (data + 32, va_arg (ap, const char *), 16);
1253 #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
1254 DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH;
1255 /* GCC 8.0 and 8.1 warn about 80 equals destination size with
1256 -Wstringop-truncation:
1257 https://gcc.gnu.org/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=85643
1258 */
1259 DIAGNOSTIC_IGNORE_STRINGOP_TRUNCATION;
1260 #endif
1261 strncpy (data + 48, va_arg (ap, const char *), 80);
1262 #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
1263 DIAGNOSTIC_POP;
1264 #endif
1265 va_end (ap);
1266 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
1267 "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
1268 }
1269
1270 case NT_PRSTATUS:
1271 {
1272 char data[268];
1273 va_list ap;
1274 long pid;
1275 int cursig;
1276 const void *greg;
1277
1278 va_start (ap, note_type);
1279 memset (data, 0, 72);
1280 pid = va_arg (ap, long);
1281 bfd_put_32 (abfd, pid, data + 24);
1282 cursig = va_arg (ap, int);
1283 bfd_put_16 (abfd, cursig, data + 12);
1284 greg = va_arg (ap, const void *);
1285 memcpy (data + 72, greg, 192);
1286 memset (data + 264, 0, 4);
1287 va_end (ap);
1288 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
1289 "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
1290 }
1291 }
1292 }
1293
1294 static flagword
1295 ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags (char *flag_name)
1296 {
1297
1298 if (!strcmp (flag_name, "SHF_PPC_VLE"))
1299 return SHF_PPC_VLE;
1300
1301 return 0;
1302 }
1303
1304 /* Return address for Ith PLT stub in section PLT, for relocation REL
1305 or (bfd_vma) -1 if it should not be included. */
1306
1307 static bfd_vma
1308 ppc_elf_plt_sym_val (bfd_vma i ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1309 const asection *plt ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1310 const arelent *rel)
1311 {
1312 return rel->address;
1313 }
1314
1315 /* Handle a PowerPC specific section when reading an object file. This
1316 is called when bfd_section_from_shdr finds a section with an unknown
1317 type. */
1318
1319 static bfd_boolean
1320 ppc_elf_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
1321 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
1322 const char *name,
1323 int shindex)
1324 {
1325 asection *newsect;
1326 flagword flags;
1327
1328 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
1329 return FALSE;
1330
1331 newsect = hdr->bfd_section;
1332 flags = bfd_get_section_flags (abfd, newsect);
1333 if (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXCLUDE)
1334 flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1335
1336 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_ORDERED)
1337 flags |= SEC_SORT_ENTRIES;
1338
1339 bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, newsect, flags);
1340 return TRUE;
1341 }
1342
1343 /* Set up any other section flags and such that may be necessary. */
1344
1345 static bfd_boolean
1346 ppc_elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1347 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr,
1348 asection *asect)
1349 {
1350 if ((asect->flags & SEC_SORT_ENTRIES) != 0)
1351 shdr->sh_type = SHT_ORDERED;
1352
1353 return TRUE;
1354 }
1355
1356 /* If we have .sbss2 or .PPC.EMB.sbss0 output sections, we
1357 need to bump up the number of section headers. */
1358
1359 static int
1360 ppc_elf_additional_program_headers (bfd *abfd,
1361 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1362 {
1363 asection *s;
1364 int ret = 0;
1365
1366 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".sbss2");
1367 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1368 ++ret;
1369
1370 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".PPC.EMB.sbss0");
1371 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1372 ++ret;
1373
1374 return ret;
1375 }
1376
1377 /* Modify the segment map for VLE executables. */
1378
1379 bfd_boolean
1380 ppc_elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
1381 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1382 {
1383 struct elf_segment_map *m;
1384
1385 /* At this point in the link, output sections have already been sorted by
1386 LMA and assigned to segments. All that is left to do is to ensure
1387 there is no mixing of VLE & non-VLE sections in a text segment.
1388 If we find that case, we split the segment.
1389 We maintain the original output section order. */
1390
1391 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
1392 {
1393 struct elf_segment_map *n;
1394 bfd_size_type amt;
1395 unsigned int j, k;
1396 unsigned int p_flags;
1397
1398 if (m->p_type != PT_LOAD || m->count == 0)
1399 continue;
1400
1401 for (p_flags = PF_R, j = 0; j != m->count; ++j)
1402 {
1403 if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
1404 p_flags |= PF_W;
1405 if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
1406 {
1407 p_flags |= PF_X;
1408 if ((elf_section_flags (m->sections[j]) & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1409 p_flags |= PF_PPC_VLE;
1410 break;
1411 }
1412 }
1413 if (j != m->count)
1414 while (++j != m->count)
1415 {
1416 unsigned int p_flags1 = PF_R;
1417
1418 if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
1419 p_flags1 |= PF_W;
1420 if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
1421 {
1422 p_flags1 |= PF_X;
1423 if ((elf_section_flags (m->sections[j]) & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1424 p_flags1 |= PF_PPC_VLE;
1425 if (((p_flags1 ^ p_flags) & PF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1426 break;
1427 }
1428 p_flags |= p_flags1;
1429 }
1430 /* If we're splitting a segment which originally contained rw
1431 sections then those sections might now only be in one of the
1432 two parts. So always set p_flags if splitting, even if we
1433 are being called for objcopy with p_flags_valid set. */
1434 if (j != m->count || !m->p_flags_valid)
1435 {
1436 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
1437 m->p_flags = p_flags;
1438 }
1439 if (j == m->count)
1440 continue;
1441
1442 /* Sections 0..j-1 stay in this (current) segment,
1443 the remainder are put in a new segment.
1444 The scan resumes with the new segment. */
1445
1446 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
1447 amt += (m->count - j - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
1448 n = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
1449 if (n == NULL)
1450 return FALSE;
1451
1452 n->p_type = PT_LOAD;
1453 n->count = m->count - j;
1454 for (k = 0; k < n->count; ++k)
1455 n->sections[k] = m->sections[j + k];
1456 m->count = j;
1457 m->p_size_valid = 0;
1458 n->next = m->next;
1459 m->next = n;
1460 }
1461
1462 return TRUE;
1463 }
1464
1465 /* Add extra PPC sections -- Note, for now, make .sbss2 and
1466 .PPC.EMB.sbss0 a normal section, and not a bss section so
1467 that the linker doesn't crater when trying to make more than
1468 2 sections. */
1469
1470 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc_elf_special_sections[] =
1471 {
1472 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
1473 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1474 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss2"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1475 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1476 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata2"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1477 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tags"), 0, SHT_ORDERED, SHF_ALLOC },
1478 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (APUINFO_SECTION_NAME), 0, SHT_NOTE, 0 },
1479 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".PPC.EMB.sbss0"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1480 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".PPC.EMB.sdata0"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1481 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
1482 };
1483
1484 /* This is what we want for new plt/got. */
1485 static struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc_alt_plt =
1486 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC };
1487
1488 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
1489 ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
1490 {
1491 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *ssect;
1492
1493 /* See if this is one of the special sections. */
1494 if (sec->name == NULL)
1495 return NULL;
1496
1497 ssect = _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name, ppc_elf_special_sections,
1498 sec->use_rela_p);
1499 if (ssect != NULL)
1500 {
1501 if (ssect == ppc_elf_special_sections && (sec->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
1502 ssect = &ppc_alt_plt;
1503 return ssect;
1504 }
1505
1506 return _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
1507 }
1508 \f
1509 /* Very simple linked list structure for recording apuinfo values. */
1510 typedef struct apuinfo_list
1511 {
1512 struct apuinfo_list *next;
1513 unsigned long value;
1514 }
1515 apuinfo_list;
1516
1517 static apuinfo_list *head;
1518 static bfd_boolean apuinfo_set;
1519
1520 static void
1521 apuinfo_list_init (void)
1522 {
1523 head = NULL;
1524 apuinfo_set = FALSE;
1525 }
1526
1527 static void
1528 apuinfo_list_add (unsigned long value)
1529 {
1530 apuinfo_list *entry = head;
1531
1532 while (entry != NULL)
1533 {
1534 if (entry->value == value)
1535 return;
1536 entry = entry->next;
1537 }
1538
1539 entry = bfd_malloc (sizeof (* entry));
1540 if (entry == NULL)
1541 return;
1542
1543 entry->value = value;
1544 entry->next = head;
1545 head = entry;
1546 }
1547
1548 static unsigned
1549 apuinfo_list_length (void)
1550 {
1551 apuinfo_list *entry;
1552 unsigned long count;
1553
1554 for (entry = head, count = 0;
1555 entry;
1556 entry = entry->next)
1557 ++ count;
1558
1559 return count;
1560 }
1561
1562 static inline unsigned long
1563 apuinfo_list_element (unsigned long number)
1564 {
1565 apuinfo_list * entry;
1566
1567 for (entry = head;
1568 entry && number --;
1569 entry = entry->next)
1570 ;
1571
1572 return entry ? entry->value : 0;
1573 }
1574
1575 static void
1576 apuinfo_list_finish (void)
1577 {
1578 apuinfo_list *entry;
1579
1580 for (entry = head; entry;)
1581 {
1582 apuinfo_list *next = entry->next;
1583 free (entry);
1584 entry = next;
1585 }
1586
1587 head = NULL;
1588 }
1589
1590 /* Scan the input BFDs and create a linked list of
1591 the APUinfo values that will need to be emitted. */
1592
1593 static void
1594 ppc_elf_begin_write_processing (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
1595 {
1596 bfd *ibfd;
1597 asection *asec;
1598 char *buffer = NULL;
1599 bfd_size_type largest_input_size = 0;
1600 unsigned i;
1601 unsigned long length;
1602 const char *error_message = NULL;
1603
1604 if (link_info == NULL)
1605 return;
1606
1607 apuinfo_list_init ();
1608
1609 /* Read in the input sections contents. */
1610 for (ibfd = link_info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
1611 {
1612 unsigned long datum;
1613
1614 asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1615 if (asec == NULL)
1616 continue;
1617
1618 /* xgettext:c-format */
1619 error_message = _("corrupt %s section in %pB");
1620 length = asec->size;
1621 if (length < 20)
1622 goto fail;
1623
1624 apuinfo_set = TRUE;
1625 if (largest_input_size < asec->size)
1626 {
1627 if (buffer)
1628 free (buffer);
1629 largest_input_size = asec->size;
1630 buffer = bfd_malloc (largest_input_size);
1631 if (!buffer)
1632 return;
1633 }
1634
1635 if (bfd_seek (ibfd, asec->filepos, SEEK_SET) != 0
1636 || (bfd_bread (buffer, length, ibfd) != length))
1637 {
1638 /* xgettext:c-format */
1639 error_message = _("unable to read in %s section from %pB");
1640 goto fail;
1641 }
1642
1643 /* Verify the contents of the header. Note - we have to
1644 extract the values this way in order to allow for a
1645 host whose endian-ness is different from the target. */
1646 datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer);
1647 if (datum != sizeof APUINFO_LABEL)
1648 goto fail;
1649
1650 datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 8);
1651 if (datum != 0x2)
1652 goto fail;
1653
1654 if (strcmp (buffer + 12, APUINFO_LABEL) != 0)
1655 goto fail;
1656
1657 /* Get the number of bytes used for apuinfo entries. */
1658 datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 4);
1659 if (datum + 20 != length)
1660 goto fail;
1661
1662 /* Scan the apuinfo section, building a list of apuinfo numbers. */
1663 for (i = 0; i < datum; i += 4)
1664 apuinfo_list_add (bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 20 + i));
1665 }
1666
1667 error_message = NULL;
1668
1669 if (apuinfo_set)
1670 {
1671 /* Compute the size of the output section. */
1672 unsigned num_entries = apuinfo_list_length ();
1673
1674 /* Set the output section size, if it exists. */
1675 asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1676
1677 if (asec && ! bfd_set_section_size (abfd, asec, 20 + num_entries * 4))
1678 {
1679 ibfd = abfd;
1680 /* xgettext:c-format */
1681 error_message = _("warning: unable to set size of %s section in %pB");
1682 }
1683 }
1684
1685 fail:
1686 if (buffer)
1687 free (buffer);
1688
1689 if (error_message)
1690 _bfd_error_handler (error_message, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME, ibfd);
1691 }
1692
1693 /* Prevent the output section from accumulating the input sections'
1694 contents. We have already stored this in our linked list structure. */
1695
1696 static bfd_boolean
1697 ppc_elf_write_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1698 struct bfd_link_info *link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1699 asection *asec,
1700 bfd_byte *contents ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1701 {
1702 return apuinfo_set && strcmp (asec->name, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME) == 0;
1703 }
1704
1705 /* Finally we can generate the output section. */
1706
1707 static void
1708 ppc_elf_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd, bfd_boolean linker ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1709 {
1710 bfd_byte *buffer;
1711 asection *asec;
1712 unsigned i;
1713 unsigned num_entries;
1714 bfd_size_type length;
1715
1716 asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1717 if (asec == NULL)
1718 return;
1719
1720 if (!apuinfo_set)
1721 return;
1722
1723 length = asec->size;
1724 if (length < 20)
1725 return;
1726
1727 buffer = bfd_malloc (length);
1728 if (buffer == NULL)
1729 {
1730 _bfd_error_handler
1731 (_("failed to allocate space for new APUinfo section"));
1732 return;
1733 }
1734
1735 /* Create the apuinfo header. */
1736 num_entries = apuinfo_list_length ();
1737 bfd_put_32 (abfd, sizeof APUINFO_LABEL, buffer);
1738 bfd_put_32 (abfd, num_entries * 4, buffer + 4);
1739 bfd_put_32 (abfd, 0x2, buffer + 8);
1740 strcpy ((char *) buffer + 12, APUINFO_LABEL);
1741
1742 length = 20;
1743 for (i = 0; i < num_entries; i++)
1744 {
1745 bfd_put_32 (abfd, apuinfo_list_element (i), buffer + length);
1746 length += 4;
1747 }
1748
1749 if (length != asec->size)
1750 _bfd_error_handler (_("failed to compute new APUinfo section"));
1751
1752 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, asec, buffer, (file_ptr) 0, length))
1753 _bfd_error_handler (_("failed to install new APUinfo section"));
1754
1755 free (buffer);
1756
1757 apuinfo_list_finish ();
1758 }
1759 \f
1760 static bfd_boolean
1761 is_nonpic_glink_stub (bfd *abfd, asection *glink, bfd_vma off)
1762 {
1763 bfd_byte buf[4 * 4];
1764
1765 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf, off, sizeof buf))
1766 return FALSE;
1767
1768 return ((bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 0) & 0xffff0000) == LIS_11
1769 && (bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 4) & 0xffff0000) == LWZ_11_11
1770 && bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 8) == MTCTR_11
1771 && bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 12) == BCTR);
1772 }
1773
1774 static bfd_boolean
1775 section_covers_vma (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *section, void *ptr)
1776 {
1777 bfd_vma vma = *(bfd_vma *) ptr;
1778 return ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
1779 && section->vma <= vma
1780 && vma < section->vma + section->size);
1781 }
1782
1783 static long
1784 ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd, long symcount, asymbol **syms,
1785 long dynsymcount, asymbol **dynsyms,
1786 asymbol **ret)
1787 {
1788 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
1789 asection *plt, *relplt, *dynamic, *glink;
1790 bfd_vma glink_vma = 0;
1791 bfd_vma resolv_vma = 0;
1792 bfd_vma stub_off;
1793 asymbol *s;
1794 arelent *p;
1795 long count, i, stub_delta;
1796 size_t size;
1797 char *names;
1798 bfd_byte buf[4];
1799
1800 *ret = NULL;
1801
1802 if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0)
1803 return 0;
1804
1805 if (dynsymcount <= 0)
1806 return 0;
1807
1808 relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rela.plt");
1809 if (relplt == NULL)
1810 return 0;
1811
1812 plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
1813 if (plt == NULL)
1814 return 0;
1815
1816 /* Call common code to handle old-style executable PLTs. */
1817 if (elf_section_flags (plt) & SHF_EXECINSTR)
1818 return _bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (abfd, symcount, syms,
1819 dynsymcount, dynsyms, ret);
1820
1821 /* If this object was prelinked, the prelinker stored the address
1822 of .glink at got[1]. If it wasn't prelinked, got[1] will be zero. */
1823 dynamic = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
1824 if (dynamic != NULL)
1825 {
1826 bfd_byte *dynbuf, *extdyn, *extdynend;
1827 size_t extdynsize;
1828 void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
1829
1830 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, dynamic, &dynbuf))
1831 return -1;
1832
1833 extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
1834 swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
1835
1836 extdyn = dynbuf;
1837 extdynend = extdyn + dynamic->size;
1838 for (; extdyn < extdynend; extdyn += extdynsize)
1839 {
1840 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
1841 (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
1842
1843 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
1844 break;
1845
1846 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_PPC_GOT)
1847 {
1848 unsigned int g_o_t = dyn.d_un.d_val;
1849 asection *got = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got");
1850 if (got != NULL
1851 && bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, got, buf,
1852 g_o_t - got->vma + 4, 4))
1853 glink_vma = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1854 break;
1855 }
1856 }
1857 free (dynbuf);
1858 }
1859
1860 /* Otherwise we read the first plt entry. */
1861 if (glink_vma == 0)
1862 {
1863 if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, plt, buf, 0, 4))
1864 glink_vma = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1865 }
1866
1867 if (glink_vma == 0)
1868 return 0;
1869
1870 /* The .glink section usually does not survive the final
1871 link; search for the section (usually .text) where the
1872 glink stubs now reside. */
1873 glink = bfd_sections_find_if (abfd, section_covers_vma, &glink_vma);
1874 if (glink == NULL)
1875 return 0;
1876
1877 /* Determine glink PLT resolver by reading the relative branch
1878 from the first glink stub. */
1879 if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
1880 glink_vma - glink->vma, 4))
1881 {
1882 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1883
1884 /* The first glink stub may either branch to the resolver ... */
1885 insn ^= B;
1886 if ((insn & ~0x3fffffc) == 0)
1887 resolv_vma = glink_vma + (insn ^ 0x2000000) - 0x2000000;
1888
1889 /* ... or fall through a bunch of NOPs. */
1890 else if ((insn ^ B ^ NOP) == 0)
1891 for (i = 4;
1892 bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
1893 glink_vma - glink->vma + i, 4);
1894 i += 4)
1895 if (bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf) != NOP)
1896 {
1897 resolv_vma = glink_vma + i;
1898 break;
1899 }
1900 }
1901
1902 count = relplt->size / sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
1903 /* If the stubs are those for -shared/-pie then we might have
1904 multiple stubs for each plt entry. If that is the case then
1905 there is no way to associate stubs with their plt entries short
1906 of figuring out the GOT pointer value used in the stub.
1907 The offsets tested here need to cover all possible values of
1908 GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE for other than __tls_get_addr_opt. */
1909 stub_off = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1910 for (stub_delta = 16; stub_delta <= 32; stub_delta += 8)
1911 if (is_nonpic_glink_stub (abfd, glink, stub_off - stub_delta))
1912 break;
1913 if (stub_delta > 32)
1914 return 0;
1915
1916 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
1917 if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, TRUE))
1918 return -1;
1919
1920 size = count * sizeof (asymbol);
1921 p = relplt->relocation;
1922 for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p++)
1923 {
1924 size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
1925 if (p->addend != 0)
1926 size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8;
1927 }
1928
1929 size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink");
1930
1931 if (resolv_vma)
1932 size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
1933
1934 s = *ret = bfd_malloc (size);
1935 if (s == NULL)
1936 return -1;
1937
1938 stub_off = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1939 names = (char *) (s + count + 1 + (resolv_vma != 0));
1940 p = relplt->relocation + count - 1;
1941 for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
1942 {
1943 size_t len;
1944
1945 stub_off -= stub_delta;
1946 if (strcmp ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, "__tls_get_addr_opt") == 0)
1947 stub_off -= 32;
1948 *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
1949 /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set. Since
1950 we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set. */
1951 if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
1952 s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
1953 s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
1954 s->section = glink;
1955 s->value = stub_off;
1956 s->name = names;
1957 s->udata.p = NULL;
1958 len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
1959 memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
1960 names += len;
1961 if (p->addend != 0)
1962 {
1963 memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
1964 names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
1965 bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, names, p->addend);
1966 names += strlen (names);
1967 }
1968 memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
1969 names += sizeof ("@plt");
1970 ++s;
1971 --p;
1972 }
1973
1974 /* Add a symbol at the start of the glink branch table. */
1975 memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
1976 s->the_bfd = abfd;
1977 s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
1978 s->section = glink;
1979 s->value = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1980 s->name = names;
1981 memcpy (names, "__glink", sizeof ("__glink"));
1982 names += sizeof ("__glink");
1983 s++;
1984 count++;
1985
1986 if (resolv_vma)
1987 {
1988 /* Add a symbol for the glink PLT resolver. */
1989 memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
1990 s->the_bfd = abfd;
1991 s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
1992 s->section = glink;
1993 s->value = resolv_vma - glink->vma;
1994 s->name = names;
1995 memcpy (names, "__glink_PLTresolve", sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve"));
1996 names += sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
1997 s++;
1998 count++;
1999 }
2000
2001 return count;
2002 }
2003 \f
2004 /* The following functions are specific to the ELF linker, while
2005 functions above are used generally. They appear in this file more
2006 or less in the order in which they are called. eg.
2007 ppc_elf_check_relocs is called early in the link process,
2008 ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections is one of the last functions
2009 called. */
2010
2011 /* Track PLT entries needed for a given symbol. We might need more
2012 than one glink entry per symbol when generating a pic binary. */
2013 struct plt_entry
2014 {
2015 struct plt_entry *next;
2016
2017 /* -fPIC uses multiple GOT sections, one per file, called ".got2".
2018 This field stores the offset into .got2 used to initialise the
2019 GOT pointer reg. It will always be at least 32768. (Current
2020 gcc always uses an offset of 32768, but ld -r will pack .got2
2021 sections together resulting in larger offsets). */
2022 bfd_vma addend;
2023
2024 /* The .got2 section. */
2025 asection *sec;
2026
2027 /* PLT refcount or offset. */
2028 union
2029 {
2030 bfd_signed_vma refcount;
2031 bfd_vma offset;
2032 } plt;
2033
2034 /* .glink stub offset. */
2035 bfd_vma glink_offset;
2036 };
2037
2038 /* Of those relocs that might be copied as dynamic relocs, this
2039 function selects those that must be copied when linking a shared
2040 library or PIE, even when the symbol is local. */
2041
2042 static int
2043 must_be_dyn_reloc (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2044 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2045 {
2046 switch (r_type)
2047 {
2048 default:
2049 /* Only relative relocs can be resolved when the object load
2050 address isn't fixed. DTPREL32 is excluded because the
2051 dynamic linker needs to differentiate global dynamic from
2052 local dynamic __tls_index pairs when PPC_OPT_TLS is set. */
2053 return 1;
2054
2055 case R_PPC_REL24:
2056 case R_PPC_REL14:
2057 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
2058 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
2059 case R_PPC_REL32:
2060 return 0;
2061
2062 case R_PPC_TPREL32:
2063 case R_PPC_TPREL16:
2064 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
2065 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
2066 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
2067 /* These relocations are relative but in a shared library the
2068 linker doesn't know the thread pointer base. */
2069 return bfd_link_dll (info);
2070 }
2071 }
2072
2073 /* If ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS is non-zero, the linker will try to avoid
2074 copying dynamic variables from a shared lib into an app's dynbss
2075 section, and instead use a dynamic relocation to point into the
2076 shared lib. */
2077 #define ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS 1
2078
2079 /* Used to track dynamic relocations for local symbols. */
2080 struct ppc_dyn_relocs
2081 {
2082 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *next;
2083
2084 /* The input section of the reloc. */
2085 asection *sec;
2086
2087 /* Total number of relocs copied for the input section. */
2088 unsigned int count : 31;
2089
2090 /* Whether this entry is for STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols. */
2091 unsigned int ifunc : 1;
2092 };
2093
2094 /* PPC ELF linker hash entry. */
2095
2096 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry
2097 {
2098 struct elf_link_hash_entry elf;
2099
2100 /* If this symbol is used in the linker created sections, the processor
2101 specific backend uses this field to map the field into the offset
2102 from the beginning of the section. */
2103 elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_pointer;
2104
2105 /* Track dynamic relocs copied for this symbol. */
2106 struct elf_dyn_relocs *dyn_relocs;
2107
2108 /* Contexts in which symbol is used in the GOT.
2109 Bits are or'd into the mask as the corresponding relocs are
2110 encountered during check_relocs, with TLS_TLS being set when any
2111 of the other TLS bits are set. tls_optimize clears bits when
2112 optimizing to indicate the corresponding GOT entry type is not
2113 needed. If set, TLS_TLS is never cleared. tls_optimize may also
2114 set TLS_GDIE when a GD reloc turns into an IE one.
2115 These flags are also kept for local symbols. */
2116 #define TLS_TLS 1 /* Any TLS reloc. */
2117 #define TLS_GD 2 /* GD reloc. */
2118 #define TLS_LD 4 /* LD reloc. */
2119 #define TLS_TPREL 8 /* TPREL reloc, => IE. */
2120 #define TLS_DTPREL 16 /* DTPREL reloc, => LD. */
2121 #define TLS_MARK 32 /* __tls_get_addr call marked. */
2122 #define TLS_GDIE 64 /* GOT TPREL reloc resulting from GD->IE. */
2123 unsigned char tls_mask;
2124
2125 /* The above field is also used to mark function symbols. In which
2126 case TLS_TLS will be 0. */
2127 #define PLT_IFUNC 2 /* STT_GNU_IFUNC. */
2128 #define PLT_KEEP 4 /* inline plt call requires plt entry. */
2129 #define NON_GOT 256 /* local symbol plt, not stored. */
2130
2131 /* Nonzero if we have seen a small data relocation referring to this
2132 symbol. */
2133 unsigned char has_sda_refs : 1;
2134
2135 /* Flag use of given relocations. */
2136 unsigned char has_addr16_ha : 1;
2137 unsigned char has_addr16_lo : 1;
2138 };
2139
2140 #define ppc_elf_hash_entry(ent) ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) (ent))
2141
2142 /* PPC ELF linker hash table. */
2143
2144 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table
2145 {
2146 struct elf_link_hash_table elf;
2147
2148 /* Various options passed from the linker. */
2149 struct ppc_elf_params *params;
2150
2151 /* Short-cuts to get to dynamic linker sections. */
2152 asection *glink;
2153 asection *dynsbss;
2154 asection *relsbss;
2155 elf_linker_section_t sdata[2];
2156 asection *sbss;
2157 asection *glink_eh_frame;
2158 asection *pltlocal;
2159 asection *relpltlocal;
2160
2161 /* The (unloaded but important) .rela.plt.unloaded on VxWorks. */
2162 asection *srelplt2;
2163
2164 /* Shortcut to __tls_get_addr. */
2165 struct elf_link_hash_entry *tls_get_addr;
2166
2167 /* The bfd that forced an old-style PLT. */
2168 bfd *old_bfd;
2169
2170 /* TLS local dynamic got entry handling. */
2171 union {
2172 bfd_signed_vma refcount;
2173 bfd_vma offset;
2174 } tlsld_got;
2175
2176 /* Offset of branch table to PltResolve function in glink. */
2177 bfd_vma glink_pltresolve;
2178
2179 /* Size of reserved GOT entries. */
2180 unsigned int got_header_size;
2181 /* Non-zero if allocating the header left a gap. */
2182 unsigned int got_gap;
2183
2184 /* The type of PLT we have chosen to use. */
2185 enum ppc_elf_plt_type plt_type;
2186
2187 /* True if the target system is VxWorks. */
2188 unsigned int is_vxworks:1;
2189
2190 /* Whether there exist local gnu indirect function resolvers,
2191 referenced by dynamic relocations. */
2192 unsigned int local_ifunc_resolver:1;
2193 unsigned int maybe_local_ifunc_resolver:1;
2194
2195 /* Set if tls optimization is enabled. */
2196 unsigned int do_tls_opt:1;
2197
2198 /* Set if inline plt calls should be converted to direct calls. */
2199 unsigned int can_convert_all_inline_plt:1;
2200
2201 /* The size of PLT entries. */
2202 int plt_entry_size;
2203 /* The distance between adjacent PLT slots. */
2204 int plt_slot_size;
2205 /* The size of the first PLT entry. */
2206 int plt_initial_entry_size;
2207
2208 /* Small local sym cache. */
2209 struct sym_cache sym_cache;
2210 };
2211
2212 /* Rename some of the generic section flags to better document how they
2213 are used for ppc32. The flags are only valid for ppc32 elf objects. */
2214
2215 /* Nonzero if this section has TLS related relocations. */
2216 #define has_tls_reloc sec_flg0
2217
2218 /* Nonzero if this section has a call to __tls_get_addr. */
2219 #define has_tls_get_addr_call sec_flg1
2220
2221 /* Flag set when PLTCALL relocs are detected. */
2222 #define has_pltcall sec_flg2
2223
2224 /* Get the PPC ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure. */
2225
2226 #define ppc_elf_hash_table(p) \
2227 (elf_hash_table_id ((struct elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) \
2228 == PPC32_ELF_DATA ? ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) : NULL)
2229
2230 /* Create an entry in a PPC ELF linker hash table. */
2231
2232 static struct bfd_hash_entry *
2233 ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
2234 struct bfd_hash_table *table,
2235 const char *string)
2236 {
2237 /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
2238 subclass. */
2239 if (entry == NULL)
2240 {
2241 entry = bfd_hash_allocate (table,
2242 sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry));
2243 if (entry == NULL)
2244 return entry;
2245 }
2246
2247 /* Call the allocation method of the superclass. */
2248 entry = _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc (entry, table, string);
2249 if (entry != NULL)
2250 {
2251 ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->linker_section_pointer = NULL;
2252 ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
2253 ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->tls_mask = 0;
2254 ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->has_sda_refs = 0;
2255 }
2256
2257 return entry;
2258 }
2259
2260 /* Create a PPC ELF linker hash table. */
2261
2262 static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
2263 ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
2264 {
2265 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *ret;
2266 static struct ppc_elf_params default_params
2267 = { PLT_OLD, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 12, 0, 0, 0 };
2268
2269 ret = bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table));
2270 if (ret == NULL)
2271 return NULL;
2272
2273 if (!_bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&ret->elf, abfd,
2274 ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc,
2275 sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry),
2276 PPC32_ELF_DATA))
2277 {
2278 free (ret);
2279 return NULL;
2280 }
2281
2282 ret->elf.init_plt_refcount.refcount = 0;
2283 ret->elf.init_plt_refcount.glist = NULL;
2284 ret->elf.init_plt_offset.offset = 0;
2285 ret->elf.init_plt_offset.glist = NULL;
2286
2287 ret->params = &default_params;
2288
2289 ret->sdata[0].name = ".sdata";
2290 ret->sdata[0].sym_name = "_SDA_BASE_";
2291 ret->sdata[0].bss_name = ".sbss";
2292
2293 ret->sdata[1].name = ".sdata2";
2294 ret->sdata[1].sym_name = "_SDA2_BASE_";
2295 ret->sdata[1].bss_name = ".sbss2";
2296
2297 ret->plt_entry_size = 12;
2298 ret->plt_slot_size = 8;
2299 ret->plt_initial_entry_size = 72;
2300
2301 return &ret->elf.root;
2302 }
2303
2304 /* Hook linker params into hash table. */
2305
2306 void
2307 ppc_elf_link_params (struct bfd_link_info *info, struct ppc_elf_params *params)
2308 {
2309 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2310
2311 if (htab)
2312 htab->params = params;
2313 params->pagesize_p2 = bfd_log2 (params->pagesize);
2314 }
2315
2316 /* Create .got and the related sections. */
2317
2318 static bfd_boolean
2319 ppc_elf_create_got (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2320 {
2321 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2322
2323 if (!_bfd_elf_create_got_section (abfd, info))
2324 return FALSE;
2325
2326 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2327 if (!htab->is_vxworks)
2328 {
2329 /* The powerpc .got has a blrl instruction in it. Mark it
2330 executable. */
2331 flagword flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2332 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2333 if (!bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, htab->elf.sgot, flags))
2334 return FALSE;
2335 }
2336
2337 return TRUE;
2338 }
2339
2340 /* Create a special linker section, used for R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16 and
2341 R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16 pointers. These sections become part of .sdata
2342 and .sdata2. Create _SDA_BASE_ and _SDA2_BASE too. */
2343
2344 static bfd_boolean
2345 ppc_elf_create_linker_section (bfd *abfd,
2346 struct bfd_link_info *info,
2347 flagword flags,
2348 elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
2349 {
2350 asection *s;
2351
2352 flags |= (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
2353 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2354
2355 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, lsect->name, flags);
2356 if (s == NULL)
2357 return FALSE;
2358 lsect->section = s;
2359
2360 /* Define the sym on the first section of this name. */
2361 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, lsect->name);
2362
2363 lsect->sym = _bfd_elf_define_linkage_sym (abfd, info, s, lsect->sym_name);
2364 if (lsect->sym == NULL)
2365 return FALSE;
2366 lsect->sym->root.u.def.value = 0x8000;
2367 return TRUE;
2368 }
2369
2370 static bfd_boolean
2371 ppc_elf_create_glink (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2372 {
2373 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2374 asection *s;
2375 flagword flags;
2376 int p2align;
2377
2378 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2379 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2380 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".glink", flags);
2381 htab->glink = s;
2382 p2align = htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? 6 : 4;
2383 if (p2align < htab->params->plt_stub_align)
2384 p2align = htab->params->plt_stub_align;
2385 if (s == NULL
2386 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, p2align))
2387 return FALSE;
2388
2389 if (!info->no_ld_generated_unwind_info)
2390 {
2391 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2392 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2393 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".eh_frame", flags);
2394 htab->glink_eh_frame = s;
2395 if (s == NULL
2396 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 2))
2397 return FALSE;
2398 }
2399
2400 flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2401 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".iplt", flags);
2402 htab->elf.iplt = s;
2403 if (s == NULL
2404 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 4))
2405 return FALSE;
2406
2407 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2408 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2409 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.iplt", flags);
2410 htab->elf.irelplt = s;
2411 if (s == NULL
2412 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 2))
2413 return FALSE;
2414
2415 /* Local plt entries. */
2416 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD
2417 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2418 htab->pltlocal = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".branch_lt",
2419 flags);
2420 if (htab->pltlocal == NULL
2421 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, htab->pltlocal, 2))
2422 return FALSE;
2423
2424 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
2425 {
2426 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY
2427 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2428 htab->relpltlocal
2429 = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.branch_lt", flags);
2430 if (htab->relpltlocal == NULL
2431 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, htab->relpltlocal, 2))
2432 return FALSE;
2433 }
2434
2435 if (!ppc_elf_create_linker_section (abfd, info, 0,
2436 &htab->sdata[0]))
2437 return FALSE;
2438
2439 if (!ppc_elf_create_linker_section (abfd, info, SEC_READONLY,
2440 &htab->sdata[1]))
2441 return FALSE;
2442
2443 return TRUE;
2444 }
2445
2446 /* We have to create .dynsbss and .rela.sbss here so that they get mapped
2447 to output sections (just like _bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections has
2448 to create .dynbss and .rela.bss). */
2449
2450 static bfd_boolean
2451 ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2452 {
2453 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2454 asection *s;
2455 flagword flags;
2456
2457 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2458
2459 if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL
2460 && !ppc_elf_create_got (abfd, info))
2461 return FALSE;
2462
2463 if (!_bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info))
2464 return FALSE;
2465
2466 if (htab->glink == NULL
2467 && !ppc_elf_create_glink (abfd, info))
2468 return FALSE;
2469
2470 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".dynsbss",
2471 SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2472 htab->dynsbss = s;
2473 if (s == NULL)
2474 return FALSE;
2475
2476 if (! bfd_link_pic (info))
2477 {
2478 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2479 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2480 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.sbss", flags);
2481 htab->relsbss = s;
2482 if (s == NULL
2483 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 2))
2484 return FALSE;
2485 }
2486
2487 if (htab->is_vxworks
2488 && !elf_vxworks_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info, &htab->srelplt2))
2489 return FALSE;
2490
2491 s = htab->elf.splt;
2492 flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2493 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
2494 /* The VxWorks PLT is a loaded section with contents. */
2495 flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY;
2496 return bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, s, flags);
2497 }
2498
2499 /* Copy the extra info we tack onto an elf_link_hash_entry. */
2500
2501 static void
2502 ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2503 struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
2504 struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
2505 {
2506 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *edir, *eind;
2507
2508 edir = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) dir;
2509 eind = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) ind;
2510
2511 edir->tls_mask |= eind->tls_mask;
2512 edir->has_sda_refs |= eind->has_sda_refs;
2513
2514 if (edir->elf.versioned != versioned_hidden)
2515 edir->elf.ref_dynamic |= eind->elf.ref_dynamic;
2516 edir->elf.ref_regular |= eind->elf.ref_regular;
2517 edir->elf.ref_regular_nonweak |= eind->elf.ref_regular_nonweak;
2518 edir->elf.non_got_ref |= eind->elf.non_got_ref;
2519 edir->elf.needs_plt |= eind->elf.needs_plt;
2520 edir->elf.pointer_equality_needed |= eind->elf.pointer_equality_needed;
2521
2522 /* If we were called to copy over info for a weak sym, that's all. */
2523 if (eind->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_indirect)
2524 return;
2525
2526 if (eind->dyn_relocs != NULL)
2527 {
2528 if (edir->dyn_relocs != NULL)
2529 {
2530 struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
2531 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
2532
2533 /* Add reloc counts against the indirect sym to the direct sym
2534 list. Merge any entries against the same section. */
2535 for (pp = &eind->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
2536 {
2537 struct elf_dyn_relocs *q;
2538
2539 for (q = edir->dyn_relocs; q != NULL; q = q->next)
2540 if (q->sec == p->sec)
2541 {
2542 q->pc_count += p->pc_count;
2543 q->count += p->count;
2544 *pp = p->next;
2545 break;
2546 }
2547 if (q == NULL)
2548 pp = &p->next;
2549 }
2550 *pp = edir->dyn_relocs;
2551 }
2552
2553 edir->dyn_relocs = eind->dyn_relocs;
2554 eind->dyn_relocs = NULL;
2555 }
2556
2557 /* Copy over the GOT refcount entries that we may have already seen to
2558 the symbol which just became indirect. */
2559 edir->elf.got.refcount += eind->elf.got.refcount;
2560 eind->elf.got.refcount = 0;
2561
2562 /* And plt entries. */
2563 if (eind->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
2564 {
2565 if (edir->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
2566 {
2567 struct plt_entry **entp;
2568 struct plt_entry *ent;
2569
2570 for (entp = &eind->elf.plt.plist; (ent = *entp) != NULL; )
2571 {
2572 struct plt_entry *dent;
2573
2574 for (dent = edir->elf.plt.plist; dent != NULL; dent = dent->next)
2575 if (dent->sec == ent->sec && dent->addend == ent->addend)
2576 {
2577 dent->plt.refcount += ent->plt.refcount;
2578 *entp = ent->next;
2579 break;
2580 }
2581 if (dent == NULL)
2582 entp = &ent->next;
2583 }
2584 *entp = edir->elf.plt.plist;
2585 }
2586
2587 edir->elf.plt.plist = eind->elf.plt.plist;
2588 eind->elf.plt.plist = NULL;
2589 }
2590
2591 if (eind->elf.dynindx != -1)
2592 {
2593 if (edir->elf.dynindx != -1)
2594 _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
2595 edir->elf.dynstr_index);
2596 edir->elf.dynindx = eind->elf.dynindx;
2597 edir->elf.dynstr_index = eind->elf.dynstr_index;
2598 eind->elf.dynindx = -1;
2599 eind->elf.dynstr_index = 0;
2600 }
2601 }
2602
2603 /* Hook called by the linker routine which adds symbols from an object
2604 file. We use it to put .comm items in .sbss, and not .bss. */
2605
2606 static bfd_boolean
2607 ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd,
2608 struct bfd_link_info *info,
2609 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
2610 const char **namep ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2611 flagword *flagsp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2612 asection **secp,
2613 bfd_vma *valp)
2614 {
2615 if (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
2616 && !bfd_link_relocatable (info)
2617 && is_ppc_elf (info->output_bfd)
2618 && sym->st_size <= elf_gp_size (abfd))
2619 {
2620 /* Common symbols less than or equal to -G nn bytes are automatically
2621 put into .sbss. */
2622 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2623
2624 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2625 if (htab->sbss == NULL)
2626 {
2627 flagword flags = SEC_IS_COMMON | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2628
2629 if (!htab->elf.dynobj)
2630 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2631
2632 htab->sbss = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (htab->elf.dynobj,
2633 ".sbss",
2634 flags);
2635 if (htab->sbss == NULL)
2636 return FALSE;
2637 }
2638
2639 *secp = htab->sbss;
2640 *valp = sym->st_size;
2641 }
2642
2643 return TRUE;
2644 }
2645 \f
2646 /* Find a linker generated pointer with a given addend and type. */
2647
2648 static elf_linker_section_pointers_t *
2649 elf_find_pointer_linker_section
2650 (elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_pointers,
2651 bfd_vma addend,
2652 elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
2653 {
2654 for ( ; linker_pointers != NULL; linker_pointers = linker_pointers->next)
2655 if (lsect == linker_pointers->lsect && addend == linker_pointers->addend)
2656 return linker_pointers;
2657
2658 return NULL;
2659 }
2660
2661 /* Allocate a pointer to live in a linker created section. */
2662
2663 static bfd_boolean
2664 elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (bfd *abfd,
2665 elf_linker_section_t *lsect,
2666 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2667 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
2668 {
2669 elf_linker_section_pointers_t **ptr_linker_section_ptr = NULL;
2670 elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_ptr;
2671 unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
2672 bfd_size_type amt;
2673
2674 BFD_ASSERT (lsect != NULL);
2675
2676 /* Is this a global symbol? */
2677 if (h != NULL)
2678 {
2679 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
2680
2681 /* Has this symbol already been allocated? If so, our work is done. */
2682 eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2683 if (elf_find_pointer_linker_section (eh->linker_section_pointer,
2684 rel->r_addend,
2685 lsect))
2686 return TRUE;
2687
2688 ptr_linker_section_ptr = &eh->linker_section_pointer;
2689 }
2690 else
2691 {
2692 BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (abfd));
2693
2694 /* Allocation of a pointer to a local symbol. */
2695 elf_linker_section_pointers_t **ptr = elf_local_ptr_offsets (abfd);
2696
2697 /* Allocate a table to hold the local symbols if first time. */
2698 if (!ptr)
2699 {
2700 unsigned int num_symbols = elf_symtab_hdr (abfd).sh_info;
2701
2702 amt = num_symbols;
2703 amt *= sizeof (elf_linker_section_pointers_t *);
2704 ptr = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
2705
2706 if (!ptr)
2707 return FALSE;
2708
2709 elf_local_ptr_offsets (abfd) = ptr;
2710 }
2711
2712 /* Has this symbol already been allocated? If so, our work is done. */
2713 if (elf_find_pointer_linker_section (ptr[r_symndx],
2714 rel->r_addend,
2715 lsect))
2716 return TRUE;
2717
2718 ptr_linker_section_ptr = &ptr[r_symndx];
2719 }
2720
2721 /* Allocate space for a pointer in the linker section, and allocate
2722 a new pointer record from internal memory. */
2723 BFD_ASSERT (ptr_linker_section_ptr != NULL);
2724 amt = sizeof (elf_linker_section_pointers_t);
2725 linker_section_ptr = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
2726
2727 if (!linker_section_ptr)
2728 return FALSE;
2729
2730 linker_section_ptr->next = *ptr_linker_section_ptr;
2731 linker_section_ptr->addend = rel->r_addend;
2732 linker_section_ptr->lsect = lsect;
2733 *ptr_linker_section_ptr = linker_section_ptr;
2734
2735 if (!bfd_set_section_alignment (lsect->section->owner, lsect->section, 2))
2736 return FALSE;
2737 linker_section_ptr->offset = lsect->section->size;
2738 lsect->section->size += 4;
2739
2740 #ifdef DEBUG
2741 fprintf (stderr,
2742 "Create pointer in linker section %s, offset = %ld, section size = %ld\n",
2743 lsect->name, (long) linker_section_ptr->offset,
2744 (long) lsect->section->size);
2745 #endif
2746
2747 return TRUE;
2748 }
2749
2750 static struct plt_entry **
2751 update_local_sym_info (bfd *abfd,
2752 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
2753 unsigned long r_symndx,
2754 int tls_type)
2755 {
2756 bfd_signed_vma *local_got_refcounts = elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd);
2757 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
2758 unsigned char *local_got_tls_masks;
2759
2760 if (local_got_refcounts == NULL)
2761 {
2762 bfd_size_type size = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
2763
2764 size *= (sizeof (*local_got_refcounts)
2765 + sizeof (*local_plt)
2766 + sizeof (*local_got_tls_masks));
2767 local_got_refcounts = bfd_zalloc (abfd, size);
2768 if (local_got_refcounts == NULL)
2769 return NULL;
2770 elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd) = local_got_refcounts;
2771 }
2772
2773 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_refcounts + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
2774 local_got_tls_masks = (unsigned char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
2775 local_got_tls_masks[r_symndx] |= tls_type & 0xff;
2776 if ((tls_type & NON_GOT) == 0)
2777 local_got_refcounts[r_symndx] += 1;
2778 return local_plt + r_symndx;
2779 }
2780
2781 static bfd_boolean
2782 update_plt_info (bfd *abfd, struct plt_entry **plist,
2783 asection *sec, bfd_vma addend)
2784 {
2785 struct plt_entry *ent;
2786
2787 if (addend < 32768)
2788 sec = NULL;
2789 for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
2790 if (ent->sec == sec && ent->addend == addend)
2791 break;
2792 if (ent == NULL)
2793 {
2794 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (*ent);
2795 ent = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
2796 if (ent == NULL)
2797 return FALSE;
2798 ent->next = *plist;
2799 ent->sec = sec;
2800 ent->addend = addend;
2801 ent->plt.refcount = 0;
2802 *plist = ent;
2803 }
2804 ent->plt.refcount += 1;
2805 return TRUE;
2806 }
2807
2808 static struct plt_entry *
2809 find_plt_ent (struct plt_entry **plist, asection *sec, bfd_vma addend)
2810 {
2811 struct plt_entry *ent;
2812
2813 if (addend < 32768)
2814 sec = NULL;
2815 for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
2816 if (ent->sec == sec && ent->addend == addend)
2817 break;
2818 return ent;
2819 }
2820
2821 static bfd_boolean
2822 is_branch_reloc (enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2823 {
2824 return (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
2825 || r_type == R_PPC_LOCAL24PC
2826 || r_type == R_PPC_REL24
2827 || r_type == R_PPC_REL14
2828 || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN
2829 || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN
2830 || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR24
2831 || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14
2832 || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN
2833 || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN
2834 || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_REL24);
2835 }
2836
2837 /* Relocs on inline plt call sequence insns prior to the call. */
2838
2839 static bfd_boolean
2840 is_plt_seq_reloc (enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2841 {
2842 return (r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA
2843 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
2844 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
2845 || r_type == R_PPC_PLTSEQ);
2846 }
2847
2848 static void
2849 bad_shared_reloc (bfd *abfd, enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2850 {
2851 _bfd_error_handler
2852 /* xgettext:c-format */
2853 (_("%pB: relocation %s cannot be used when making a shared object"),
2854 abfd,
2855 ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name);
2856 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
2857 }
2858
2859 /* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and
2860 allocate space in the global offset table or procedure linkage
2861 table. */
2862
2863 static bfd_boolean
2864 ppc_elf_check_relocs (bfd *abfd,
2865 struct bfd_link_info *info,
2866 asection *sec,
2867 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
2868 {
2869 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2870 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
2871 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
2872 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
2873 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end;
2874 asection *got2, *sreloc;
2875 struct elf_link_hash_entry *tga;
2876
2877 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
2878 return TRUE;
2879
2880 /* Don't do anything special with non-loaded, non-alloced sections.
2881 In particular, any relocs in such sections should not affect GOT
2882 and PLT reference counting (ie. we don't allow them to create GOT
2883 or PLT entries), there's no possibility or desire to optimize TLS
2884 relocs, and there's not much point in propagating relocs to shared
2885 libs that the dynamic linker won't relocate. */
2886 if ((sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
2887 return TRUE;
2888
2889 #ifdef DEBUG
2890 _bfd_error_handler ("ppc_elf_check_relocs called for section %pA in %pB",
2891 sec, abfd);
2892 #endif
2893
2894 BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (abfd));
2895
2896 /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
2897 if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
2898 ppc_elf_howto_init ();
2899
2900 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2901 if (htab->glink == NULL)
2902 {
2903 if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
2904 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2905 if (!ppc_elf_create_glink (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
2906 return FALSE;
2907 }
2908 tga = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
2909 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
2910 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
2911 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
2912 got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got2");
2913 sreloc = NULL;
2914
2915 rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
2916 for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; rel++)
2917 {
2918 unsigned long r_symndx;
2919 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
2920 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
2921 int tls_type;
2922 struct plt_entry **ifunc;
2923 struct plt_entry **pltent;
2924 bfd_vma addend;
2925
2926 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
2927 if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
2928 h = NULL;
2929 else
2930 {
2931 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
2932 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
2933 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
2934 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
2935 }
2936
2937 /* If a relocation refers to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_, create the .got.
2938 This shows up in particular in an R_PPC_ADDR32 in the eabi
2939 startup code. */
2940 if (h != NULL
2941 && htab->elf.sgot == NULL
2942 && strcmp (h->root.root.string, "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_") == 0)
2943 {
2944 if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
2945 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2946 if (!ppc_elf_create_got (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
2947 return FALSE;
2948 BFD_ASSERT (h == htab->elf.hgot);
2949 }
2950
2951 tls_type = 0;
2952 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
2953 ifunc = NULL;
2954 if (h == NULL && !htab->is_vxworks)
2955 {
2956 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
2957 abfd, r_symndx);
2958 if (isym == NULL)
2959 return FALSE;
2960
2961 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
2962 {
2963 /* Set PLT_IFUNC flag for this sym, no GOT entry yet. */
2964 ifunc = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
2965 NON_GOT | PLT_IFUNC);
2966 if (ifunc == NULL)
2967 return FALSE;
2968
2969 /* STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols must have a PLT entry;
2970 In a non-pie executable even when there are
2971 no plt calls. */
2972 if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
2973 || is_branch_reloc (r_type)
2974 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
2975 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
2976 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA)
2977 {
2978 addend = 0;
2979 if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
2980 ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->makes_plt_call = 1;
2981 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
2982 && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
2983 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
2984 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
2985 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
2986 addend = rel->r_addend;
2987 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, ifunc, got2, addend))
2988 return FALSE;
2989 }
2990 }
2991 }
2992
2993 if (!htab->is_vxworks
2994 && is_branch_reloc (r_type)
2995 && h != NULL
2996 && h == tga)
2997 {
2998 if (rel != relocs
2999 && (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_TLSGD
3000 || ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_TLSLD))
3001 /* We have a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a marker
3002 reloc. */
3003 ;
3004 else
3005 /* Mark this section as having an old-style call. */
3006 sec->has_tls_get_addr_call = 1;
3007 }
3008
3009 switch (r_type)
3010 {
3011 case R_PPC_TLSGD:
3012 case R_PPC_TLSLD:
3013 /* These special tls relocs tie a call to __tls_get_addr with
3014 its parameter symbol. */
3015 if (h != NULL)
3016 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK;
3017 else
3018 if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
3019 NON_GOT | TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
3020 return FALSE;
3021 break;
3022
3023 case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
3024 break;
3025
3026 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
3027 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
3028 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
3029 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
3030 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
3031 goto dogottls;
3032
3033 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
3034 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
3035 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
3036 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
3037 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
3038 goto dogottls;
3039
3040 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
3041 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
3042 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
3043 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
3044 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
3045 info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
3046 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
3047 goto dogottls;
3048
3049 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
3050 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
3051 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
3052 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
3053 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
3054 dogottls:
3055 sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
3056 /* Fall through. */
3057
3058 /* GOT16 relocations */
3059 case R_PPC_GOT16:
3060 case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
3061 case R_PPC_GOT16_HI:
3062 case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
3063 /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry. */
3064 if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
3065 {
3066 if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
3067 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
3068 if (!ppc_elf_create_got (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
3069 return FALSE;
3070 }
3071 if (h != NULL)
3072 {
3073 h->got.refcount += 1;
3074 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= tls_type;
3075 }
3076 else
3077 /* This is a global offset table entry for a local symbol. */
3078 if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx, tls_type))
3079 return FALSE;
3080
3081 /* We may also need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3082 an ifunc. */
3083 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3084 {
3085 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3086 return FALSE;
3087 }
3088 break;
3089
3090 /* Indirect .sdata relocation. */
3091 case R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:
3092 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
3093 {
3094 bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3095 return FALSE;
3096 }
3097 htab->sdata[0].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3098 if (!elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (abfd, &htab->sdata[0],
3099 h, rel))
3100 return FALSE;
3101 if (h != NULL)
3102 {
3103 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3104 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3105 }
3106 break;
3107
3108 /* Indirect .sdata2 relocation. */
3109 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:
3110 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
3111 {
3112 bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3113 return FALSE;
3114 }
3115 htab->sdata[1].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3116 if (!elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (abfd, &htab->sdata[1],
3117 h, rel))
3118 return FALSE;
3119 if (h != NULL)
3120 {
3121 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3122 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3123 }
3124 break;
3125
3126 case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
3127 htab->sdata[0].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3128 /* Fall through. */
3129
3130 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
3131 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
3132 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
3133 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
3134 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
3135 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
3136 if (h != NULL)
3137 {
3138 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3139 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3140 }
3141 break;
3142
3143 case R_PPC_VLE_REL8:
3144 case R_PPC_VLE_REL15:
3145 case R_PPC_VLE_REL24:
3146 case R_PPC_VLE_LO16A:
3147 case R_PPC_VLE_LO16D:
3148 case R_PPC_VLE_HI16A:
3149 case R_PPC_VLE_HI16D:
3150 case R_PPC_VLE_HA16A:
3151 case R_PPC_VLE_HA16D:
3152 case R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20:
3153 break;
3154
3155 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:
3156 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
3157 {
3158 bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3159 return FALSE;
3160 }
3161 htab->sdata[1].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3162 if (h != NULL)
3163 {
3164 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3165 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3166 }
3167 break;
3168
3169 case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:
3170 case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21:
3171 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA21:
3172 case R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:
3173 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
3174 {
3175 bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3176 return FALSE;
3177 }
3178 if (h != NULL)
3179 {
3180 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3181 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3182 }
3183 break;
3184
3185 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:
3186 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:
3187 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:
3188 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:
3189 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
3190 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
3191 {
3192 bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3193 return FALSE;
3194 }
3195 if (h != NULL)
3196 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3197 break;
3198
3199 case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
3200 if (h == NULL)
3201 break;
3202 ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->makes_plt_call = 1;
3203 goto pltentry;
3204
3205 case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
3206 sec->has_pltcall = 1;
3207 /* Fall through. */
3208
3209 case R_PPC_PLT32:
3210 case R_PPC_PLTREL32:
3211 case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
3212 case R_PPC_PLT16_HI:
3213 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
3214 pltentry:
3215 #ifdef DEBUG
3216 fprintf (stderr, "Reloc requires a PLT entry\n");
3217 #endif
3218 /* This symbol requires a procedure linkage table entry. */
3219 if (h == NULL)
3220 {
3221 pltent = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
3222 NON_GOT | PLT_KEEP);
3223 if (pltent == NULL)
3224 return FALSE;
3225 }
3226 else
3227 {
3228 if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
3229 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= PLT_KEEP;
3230 h->needs_plt = 1;
3231 pltent = &h->plt.plist;
3232 }
3233 addend = 0;
3234 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
3235 && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
3236 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
3237 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
3238 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
3239 addend = rel->r_addend;
3240 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, pltent, got2, addend))
3241 return FALSE;
3242 break;
3243
3244 /* The following relocations don't need to propagate the
3245 relocation if linking a shared object since they are
3246 section relative. */
3247 case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
3248 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
3249 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI:
3250 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
3251 case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
3252 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
3253 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:
3254 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
3255 case R_PPC_TOC16:
3256 break;
3257
3258 case R_PPC_REL16:
3259 case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
3260 case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
3261 case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
3262 case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
3263 ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->has_rel16 = 1;
3264 break;
3265
3266 /* These are just markers. */
3267 case R_PPC_TLS:
3268 case R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:
3269 case R_PPC_NONE:
3270 case R_PPC_max:
3271 case R_PPC_RELAX:
3272 case R_PPC_RELAX_PLT:
3273 case R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24:
3274 case R_PPC_16DX_HA:
3275 break;
3276
3277 /* These should only appear in dynamic objects. */
3278 case R_PPC_COPY:
3279 case R_PPC_GLOB_DAT:
3280 case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
3281 case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
3282 case R_PPC_IRELATIVE:
3283 break;
3284
3285 /* These aren't handled yet. We'll report an error later. */
3286 case R_PPC_ADDR30:
3287 case R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:
3288 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:
3289 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:
3290 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
3291 case R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:
3292 break;
3293
3294 /* This refers only to functions defined in the shared library. */
3295 case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
3296 if (h != NULL && h == htab->elf.hgot && htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3297 {
3298 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3299 htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3300 }
3301 if (h != NULL && h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
3302 {
3303 h->needs_plt = 1;
3304 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3305 return FALSE;
3306 }
3307 break;
3308
3309 /* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy.
3310 Reconstruct it for later use during GC. */
3311 case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
3312 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
3313 return FALSE;
3314 break;
3315
3316 /* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually
3317 used. Record for later use during GC. */
3318 case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
3319 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_addend))
3320 return FALSE;
3321 break;
3322
3323 /* We shouldn't really be seeing TPREL32. */
3324 case R_PPC_TPREL32:
3325 case R_PPC_TPREL16:
3326 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
3327 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
3328 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
3329 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
3330 info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
3331 goto dodyn;
3332
3333 /* Nor these. */
3334 case R_PPC_DTPMOD32:
3335 case R_PPC_DTPREL32:
3336 goto dodyn;
3337
3338 case R_PPC_REL32:
3339 if (h == NULL
3340 && got2 != NULL
3341 && (sec->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0
3342 && bfd_link_pic (info)
3343 && htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3344 {
3345 /* Old -fPIC gcc code has .long LCTOC1-LCFx just before
3346 the start of a function, which assembles to a REL32
3347 reference to .got2. If we detect one of these, then
3348 force the old PLT layout because the linker cannot
3349 reliably deduce the GOT pointer value needed for
3350 PLT call stubs. */
3351 asection *s;
3352 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
3353
3354 isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
3355 abfd, r_symndx);
3356 if (isym == NULL)
3357 return FALSE;
3358
3359 s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
3360 if (s == got2)
3361 {
3362 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3363 htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3364 }
3365 }
3366 if (h == NULL || h == htab->elf.hgot)
3367 break;
3368 /* fall through */
3369
3370 case R_PPC_ADDR32:
3371 case R_PPC_ADDR16:
3372 case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
3373 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HI:
3374 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
3375 case R_PPC_UADDR32:
3376 case R_PPC_UADDR16:
3377 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3378 {
3379 /* We may need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3380 a function defined in a dynamic object. */
3381 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3382 return FALSE;
3383
3384 /* We may need a copy reloc too. */
3385 h->non_got_ref = 1;
3386 h->pointer_equality_needed = 1;
3387 if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
3388 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha = 1;
3389 if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_LO)
3390 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo = 1;
3391 }
3392 goto dodyn;
3393
3394 case R_PPC_REL24:
3395 case R_PPC_REL14:
3396 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
3397 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
3398 if (h == NULL)
3399 break;
3400 if (h == htab->elf.hgot)
3401 {
3402 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3403 {
3404 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3405 htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3406 }
3407 break;
3408 }
3409 /* fall through */
3410
3411 case R_PPC_ADDR24:
3412 case R_PPC_ADDR14:
3413 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
3414 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
3415 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3416 {
3417 /* We may need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3418 a function defined in a dynamic object. */
3419 h->needs_plt = 1;
3420 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3421 return FALSE;
3422 break;
3423 }
3424
3425 dodyn:
3426 /* If we are creating a shared library, and this is a reloc
3427 against a global symbol, or a non PC relative reloc
3428 against a local symbol, then we need to copy the reloc
3429 into the shared library. However, if we are linking with
3430 -Bsymbolic, we do not need to copy a reloc against a
3431 global symbol which is defined in an object we are
3432 including in the link (i.e., DEF_REGULAR is set). At
3433 this point we have not seen all the input files, so it is
3434 possible that DEF_REGULAR is not set now but will be set
3435 later (it is never cleared). In case of a weak definition,
3436 DEF_REGULAR may be cleared later by a strong definition in
3437 a shared library. We account for that possibility below by
3438 storing information in the dyn_relocs field of the hash
3439 table entry. A similar situation occurs when creating
3440 shared libraries and symbol visibility changes render the
3441 symbol local.
3442
3443 If on the other hand, we are creating an executable, we
3444 may need to keep relocations for symbols satisfied by a
3445 dynamic library if we manage to avoid copy relocs for the
3446 symbol. */
3447 if ((bfd_link_pic (info)
3448 && (must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)
3449 || (h != NULL
3450 && (!SYMBOLIC_BIND (info, h)
3451 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
3452 || !h->def_regular))))
3453 || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
3454 && !bfd_link_pic (info)
3455 && h != NULL
3456 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
3457 || !h->def_regular)))
3458 {
3459 #ifdef DEBUG
3460 fprintf (stderr,
3461 "ppc_elf_check_relocs needs to "
3462 "create relocation for %s\n",
3463 (h && h->root.root.string
3464 ? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"));
3465 #endif
3466 if (sreloc == NULL)
3467 {
3468 if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
3469 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
3470
3471 sreloc = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_reloc_section
3472 (sec, htab->elf.dynobj, 2, abfd, /*rela?*/ TRUE);
3473
3474 if (sreloc == NULL)
3475 return FALSE;
3476 }
3477
3478 /* If this is a global symbol, we count the number of
3479 relocations we need for this symbol. */
3480 if (h != NULL)
3481 {
3482 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
3483 struct elf_dyn_relocs **rel_head;
3484
3485 rel_head = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs;
3486 p = *rel_head;
3487 if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec)
3488 {
3489 p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
3490 if (p == NULL)
3491 return FALSE;
3492 p->next = *rel_head;
3493 *rel_head = p;
3494 p->sec = sec;
3495 p->count = 0;
3496 p->pc_count = 0;
3497 }
3498 p->count += 1;
3499 if (!must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type))
3500 p->pc_count += 1;
3501 }
3502 else
3503 {
3504 /* Track dynamic relocs needed for local syms too.
3505 We really need local syms available to do this
3506 easily. Oh well. */
3507 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
3508 struct ppc_dyn_relocs **rel_head;
3509 bfd_boolean is_ifunc;
3510 asection *s;
3511 void *vpp;
3512 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
3513
3514 isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
3515 abfd, r_symndx);
3516 if (isym == NULL)
3517 return FALSE;
3518
3519 s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
3520 if (s == NULL)
3521 s = sec;
3522
3523 vpp = &elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel;
3524 rel_head = (struct ppc_dyn_relocs **) vpp;
3525 is_ifunc = ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC;
3526 p = *rel_head;
3527 if (p != NULL && p->sec == sec && p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
3528 p = p->next;
3529 if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec || p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
3530 {
3531 p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
3532 if (p == NULL)
3533 return FALSE;
3534 p->next = *rel_head;
3535 *rel_head = p;
3536 p->sec = sec;
3537 p->ifunc = is_ifunc;
3538 p->count = 0;
3539 }
3540 p->count += 1;
3541 }
3542 }
3543
3544 break;
3545 }
3546 }
3547
3548 return TRUE;
3549 }
3550 \f
3551 /* Warn for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP attributes between IBFD
3552 and OBFD, and merge non-conflicting ones. */
3553 bfd_boolean
3554 _bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3555 {
3556 bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
3557 obj_attribute *in_attr, *in_attrs;
3558 obj_attribute *out_attr, *out_attrs;
3559 bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
3560
3561 in_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3562 out_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3563
3564 in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP];
3565 out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP];
3566
3567 if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3568 {
3569 int in_fp = in_attr->i & 3;
3570 int out_fp = out_attr->i & 3;
3571 static bfd *last_fp, *last_ld;
3572
3573 if (in_fp == 0)
3574 ;
3575 else if (out_fp == 0)
3576 {
3577 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3578 out_attr->i ^= in_fp;
3579 last_fp = ibfd;
3580 }
3581 else if (out_fp != 2 && in_fp == 2)
3582 {
3583 _bfd_error_handler
3584 /* xgettext:c-format */
3585 (_("%pB uses hard float, %pB uses soft float"),
3586 last_fp, ibfd);
3587 ret = FALSE;
3588 }
3589 else if (out_fp == 2 && in_fp != 2)
3590 {
3591 _bfd_error_handler
3592 /* xgettext:c-format */
3593 (_("%pB uses hard float, %pB uses soft float"),
3594 ibfd, last_fp);
3595 ret = FALSE;
3596 }
3597 else if (out_fp == 1 && in_fp == 3)
3598 {
3599 _bfd_error_handler
3600 /* xgettext:c-format */
3601 (_("%pB uses double-precision hard float, "
3602 "%pB uses single-precision hard float"), last_fp, ibfd);
3603 ret = FALSE;
3604 }
3605 else if (out_fp == 3 && in_fp == 1)
3606 {
3607 _bfd_error_handler
3608 /* xgettext:c-format */
3609 (_("%pB uses double-precision hard float, "
3610 "%pB uses single-precision hard float"), ibfd, last_fp);
3611 ret = FALSE;
3612 }
3613
3614 in_fp = in_attr->i & 0xc;
3615 out_fp = out_attr->i & 0xc;
3616 if (in_fp == 0)
3617 ;
3618 else if (out_fp == 0)
3619 {
3620 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3621 out_attr->i ^= in_fp;
3622 last_ld = ibfd;
3623 }
3624 else if (out_fp != 2 * 4 && in_fp == 2 * 4)
3625 {
3626 _bfd_error_handler
3627 /* xgettext:c-format */
3628 (_("%pB uses 64-bit long double, "
3629 "%pB uses 128-bit long double"), ibfd, last_ld);
3630 ret = FALSE;
3631 }
3632 else if (in_fp != 2 * 4 && out_fp == 2 * 4)
3633 {
3634 _bfd_error_handler
3635 /* xgettext:c-format */
3636 (_("%pB uses 64-bit long double, "
3637 "%pB uses 128-bit long double"), last_ld, ibfd);
3638 ret = FALSE;
3639 }
3640 else if (out_fp == 1 * 4 && in_fp == 3 * 4)
3641 {
3642 _bfd_error_handler
3643 /* xgettext:c-format */
3644 (_("%pB uses IBM long double, "
3645 "%pB uses IEEE long double"), last_ld, ibfd);
3646 ret = FALSE;
3647 }
3648 else if (out_fp == 3 * 4 && in_fp == 1 * 4)
3649 {
3650 _bfd_error_handler
3651 /* xgettext:c-format */
3652 (_("%pB uses IBM long double, "
3653 "%pB uses IEEE long double"), ibfd, last_ld);
3654 ret = FALSE;
3655 }
3656 }
3657
3658 if (!ret)
3659 {
3660 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3661 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3662 }
3663 return ret;
3664 }
3665
3666 /* Merge object attributes from IBFD into OBFD. Warn if
3667 there are conflicting attributes. */
3668 static bfd_boolean
3669 ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3670 {
3671 bfd *obfd;
3672 obj_attribute *in_attr, *in_attrs;
3673 obj_attribute *out_attr, *out_attrs;
3674 bfd_boolean ret;
3675
3676 if (!_bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (ibfd, info))
3677 return FALSE;
3678
3679 obfd = info->output_bfd;
3680 in_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3681 out_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3682
3683 /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector attributes and
3684 merge non-conflicting ones. */
3685 in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector];
3686 out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector];
3687 ret = TRUE;
3688 if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3689 {
3690 int in_vec = in_attr->i & 3;
3691 int out_vec = out_attr->i & 3;
3692 static bfd *last_vec;
3693
3694 if (in_vec == 0)
3695 ;
3696 else if (out_vec == 0)
3697 {
3698 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3699 out_attr->i = in_vec;
3700 last_vec = ibfd;
3701 }
3702 /* For now, allow generic to transition to AltiVec or SPE
3703 without a warning. If GCC marked files with their stack
3704 alignment and used don't-care markings for files which are
3705 not affected by the vector ABI, we could warn about this
3706 case too. */
3707 else if (in_vec == 1)
3708 ;
3709 else if (out_vec == 1)
3710 {
3711 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3712 out_attr->i = in_vec;
3713 last_vec = ibfd;
3714 }
3715 else if (out_vec < in_vec)
3716 {
3717 _bfd_error_handler
3718 /* xgettext:c-format */
3719 (_("%pB uses AltiVec vector ABI, %pB uses SPE vector ABI"),
3720 last_vec, ibfd);
3721 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3722 ret = FALSE;
3723 }
3724 else if (out_vec > in_vec)
3725 {
3726 _bfd_error_handler
3727 /* xgettext:c-format */
3728 (_("%pB uses AltiVec vector ABI, %pB uses SPE vector ABI"),
3729 ibfd, last_vec);
3730 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3731 ret = FALSE;
3732 }
3733 }
3734
3735 /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return attributes
3736 and merge non-conflicting ones. */
3737 in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return];
3738 out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return];
3739 if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3740 {
3741 int in_struct = in_attr->i & 3;
3742 int out_struct = out_attr->i & 3;
3743 static bfd *last_struct;
3744
3745 if (in_struct == 0 || in_struct == 3)
3746 ;
3747 else if (out_struct == 0)
3748 {
3749 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3750 out_attr->i = in_struct;
3751 last_struct = ibfd;
3752 }
3753 else if (out_struct < in_struct)
3754 {
3755 _bfd_error_handler
3756 /* xgettext:c-format */
3757 (_("%pB uses r3/r4 for small structure returns, "
3758 "%pB uses memory"), last_struct, ibfd);
3759 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3760 ret = FALSE;
3761 }
3762 else if (out_struct > in_struct)
3763 {
3764 _bfd_error_handler
3765 /* xgettext:c-format */
3766 (_("%pB uses r3/r4 for small structure returns, "
3767 "%pB uses memory"), ibfd, last_struct);
3768 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3769 ret = FALSE;
3770 }
3771 }
3772 if (!ret)
3773 {
3774 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3775 return FALSE;
3776 }
3777
3778 /* Merge Tag_compatibility attributes and any common GNU ones. */
3779 return _bfd_elf_merge_object_attributes (ibfd, info);
3780 }
3781
3782 /* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output
3783 object file when linking. */
3784
3785 static bfd_boolean
3786 ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3787 {
3788 bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
3789 flagword old_flags;
3790 flagword new_flags;
3791 bfd_boolean error;
3792
3793 if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd) || !is_ppc_elf (obfd))
3794 return TRUE;
3795
3796 /* Check if we have the same endianness. */
3797 if (! _bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, info))
3798 return FALSE;
3799
3800 if (!ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes (ibfd, info))
3801 return FALSE;
3802
3803 new_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
3804 old_flags = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags;
3805 if (!elf_flags_init (obfd))
3806 {
3807 /* First call, no flags set. */
3808 elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
3809 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = new_flags;
3810 }
3811
3812 /* Compatible flags are ok. */
3813 else if (new_flags == old_flags)
3814 ;
3815
3816 /* Incompatible flags. */
3817 else
3818 {
3819 /* Warn about -mrelocatable mismatch. Allow -mrelocatable-lib
3820 to be linked with either. */
3821 error = FALSE;
3822 if ((new_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE) != 0
3823 && (old_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)) == 0)
3824 {
3825 error = TRUE;
3826 _bfd_error_handler
3827 (_("%pB: compiled with -mrelocatable and linked with "
3828 "modules compiled normally"), ibfd);
3829 }
3830 else if ((new_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)) == 0
3831 && (old_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE) != 0)
3832 {
3833 error = TRUE;
3834 _bfd_error_handler
3835 (_("%pB: compiled normally and linked with "
3836 "modules compiled with -mrelocatable"), ibfd);
3837 }
3838
3839 /* The output is -mrelocatable-lib iff both the input files are. */
3840 if (! (new_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB))
3841 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB;
3842
3843 /* The output is -mrelocatable iff it can't be -mrelocatable-lib,
3844 but each input file is either -mrelocatable or -mrelocatable-lib. */
3845 if (! (elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)
3846 && (new_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE))
3847 && (old_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE)))
3848 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE;
3849
3850 /* Do not warn about eabi vs. V.4 mismatch, just or in the bit if
3851 any module uses it. */
3852 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= (new_flags & EF_PPC_EMB);
3853
3854 new_flags &= ~(EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_EMB);
3855 old_flags &= ~(EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_EMB);
3856
3857 /* Warn about any other mismatches. */
3858 if (new_flags != old_flags)
3859 {
3860 error = TRUE;
3861 _bfd_error_handler
3862 /* xgettext:c-format */
3863 (_("%pB: uses different e_flags (%#x) fields "
3864 "than previous modules (%#x)"),
3865 ibfd, new_flags, old_flags);
3866 }
3867
3868 if (error)
3869 {
3870 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3871 return FALSE;
3872 }
3873 }
3874
3875 return TRUE;
3876 }
3877
3878 static void
3879 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (bfd *input_bfd,
3880 asection *input_section,
3881 unsigned long offset,
3882 bfd_byte *loc,
3883 bfd_vma value,
3884 split16_format_type split16_format,
3885 bfd_boolean fixup)
3886 {
3887 unsigned int insn, opcode;
3888
3889 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, loc);
3890 opcode = insn & E_OPCODE_MASK;
3891 if (opcode == E_OR2I_INSN
3892 || opcode == E_AND2I_DOT_INSN
3893 || opcode == E_OR2IS_INSN
3894 || opcode == E_LIS_INSN
3895 || opcode == E_AND2IS_DOT_INSN)
3896 {
3897 if (split16_format != split16a_type)
3898 {
3899 if (fixup)
3900 split16_format = split16a_type;
3901 else
3902 _bfd_error_handler
3903 /* xgettext:c-format */
3904 (_("%pB(%pA+0x%lx): expected 16A style relocation on 0x%08x insn"),
3905 input_bfd, input_section, offset, opcode);
3906 }
3907 }
3908 else if (opcode == E_ADD2I_DOT_INSN
3909 || opcode == E_ADD2IS_INSN
3910 || opcode == E_CMP16I_INSN
3911 || opcode == E_MULL2I_INSN
3912 || opcode == E_CMPL16I_INSN
3913 || opcode == E_CMPH16I_INSN
3914 || opcode == E_CMPHL16I_INSN)
3915 {
3916 if (split16_format != split16d_type)
3917 {
3918 if (fixup)
3919 split16_format = split16d_type;
3920 else
3921 _bfd_error_handler
3922 /* xgettext:c-format */
3923 (_("%pB(%pA+0x%lx): expected 16D style relocation on 0x%08x insn"),
3924 input_bfd, input_section, offset, opcode);
3925 }
3926 }
3927 if (split16_format == split16a_type)
3928 {
3929 insn &= ~((0xf800 << 5) | 0x7ff);
3930 insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 5;
3931 if ((insn & E_LI_MASK) == E_LI_INSN)
3932 {
3933 /* Hack for e_li. Extend sign. */
3934 insn &= ~(0xf0000 >> 5);
3935 insn |= (-(value & 0x8000) & 0xf0000) >> 5;
3936 }
3937 }
3938 else
3939 {
3940 insn &= ~((0xf800 << 10) | 0x7ff);
3941 insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 10;
3942 }
3943 insn |= value & 0x7ff;
3944 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, loc);
3945 }
3946
3947 static void
3948 ppc_elf_vle_split20 (bfd *output_bfd, bfd_byte *loc, bfd_vma value)
3949 {
3950 unsigned int insn;
3951
3952 insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc);
3953 /* We have an li20 field, bits 17..20, 11..15, 21..31. */
3954 /* Top 4 bits of value to 17..20. */
3955 insn |= (value & 0xf0000) >> 5;
3956 /* Next 5 bits of the value to 11..15. */
3957 insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 5;
3958 /* And the final 11 bits of the value to bits 21 to 31. */
3959 insn |= value & 0x7ff;
3960 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, insn, loc);
3961 }
3962
3963 \f
3964 /* Choose which PLT scheme to use, and set .plt flags appropriately.
3965 Returns -1 on error, 0 for old PLT, 1 for new PLT. */
3966 int
3967 ppc_elf_select_plt_layout (bfd *output_bfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3968 struct bfd_link_info *info)
3969 {
3970 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3971 flagword flags;
3972
3973 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
3974
3975 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3976 {
3977 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3978
3979 if (htab->params->plt_style == PLT_OLD)
3980 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3981 else if (bfd_link_pic (info)
3982 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
3983 && (h = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "_mcount",
3984 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE)) != NULL
3985 && (h->type == STT_FUNC
3986 || h->needs_plt)
3987 && h->ref_regular
3988 && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
3989 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)))
3990 {
3991 /* Profiling of shared libs (and pies) is not supported with
3992 secure plt, because ppc32 does profiling before a
3993 function prologue and a secure plt pic call stubs needs
3994 r30 to be set up. */
3995 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3996 }
3997 else
3998 {
3999 bfd *ibfd;
4000 enum ppc_elf_plt_type plt_type = htab->params->plt_style;
4001
4002 /* Look through the reloc flags left by ppc_elf_check_relocs.
4003 Use the old style bss plt if a file makes plt calls
4004 without using the new relocs, and if ld isn't given
4005 --secure-plt and we never see REL16 relocs. */
4006 if (plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
4007 plt_type = PLT_OLD;
4008 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4009 if (is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
4010 {
4011 if (ppc_elf_tdata (ibfd)->has_rel16)
4012 plt_type = PLT_NEW;
4013 else if (ppc_elf_tdata (ibfd)->makes_plt_call)
4014 {
4015 plt_type = PLT_OLD;
4016 htab->old_bfd = ibfd;
4017 break;
4018 }
4019 }
4020 htab->plt_type = plt_type;
4021 }
4022 }
4023 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD && htab->params->plt_style == PLT_NEW)
4024 {
4025 if (htab->old_bfd != NULL)
4026 _bfd_error_handler (_("bss-plt forced due to %pB"), htab->old_bfd);
4027 else
4028 _bfd_error_handler (_("bss-plt forced by profiling"));
4029 }
4030
4031 BFD_ASSERT (htab->plt_type != PLT_VXWORKS);
4032
4033 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
4034 {
4035 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
4036 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
4037
4038 /* The new PLT is a loaded section. */
4039 if (htab->elf.splt != NULL
4040 && !bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->elf.splt, flags))
4041 return -1;
4042
4043 /* The new GOT is not executable. */
4044 if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL
4045 && !bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->elf.sgot, flags))
4046 return -1;
4047 }
4048 else
4049 {
4050 /* Stop an unused .glink section from affecting .text alignment. */
4051 if (htab->glink != NULL
4052 && !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->glink, 0))
4053 return -1;
4054 }
4055 return htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW;
4056 }
4057 \f
4058 /* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given
4059 relocation. */
4060
4061 static asection *
4062 ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec,
4063 struct bfd_link_info *info,
4064 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
4065 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4066 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
4067 {
4068 if (h != NULL)
4069 switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
4070 {
4071 case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
4072 case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
4073 return NULL;
4074 }
4075
4076 return _bfd_elf_gc_mark_hook (sec, info, rel, h, sym);
4077 }
4078
4079 static bfd_boolean
4080 get_sym_h (struct elf_link_hash_entry **hp,
4081 Elf_Internal_Sym **symp,
4082 asection **symsecp,
4083 unsigned char **tls_maskp,
4084 Elf_Internal_Sym **locsymsp,
4085 unsigned long r_symndx,
4086 bfd *ibfd)
4087 {
4088 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4089
4090 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4091 {
4092 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4093 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4094
4095 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4096 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4097 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4098 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4099
4100 if (hp != NULL)
4101 *hp = h;
4102
4103 if (symp != NULL)
4104 *symp = NULL;
4105
4106 if (symsecp != NULL)
4107 {
4108 asection *symsec = NULL;
4109 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
4110 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
4111 symsec = h->root.u.def.section;
4112 *symsecp = symsec;
4113 }
4114
4115 if (tls_maskp != NULL)
4116 *tls_maskp = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask;
4117 }
4118 else
4119 {
4120 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
4121 Elf_Internal_Sym *locsyms = *locsymsp;
4122
4123 if (locsyms == NULL)
4124 {
4125 locsyms = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
4126 if (locsyms == NULL)
4127 locsyms = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (ibfd, symtab_hdr,
4128 symtab_hdr->sh_info,
4129 0, NULL, NULL, NULL);
4130 if (locsyms == NULL)
4131 return FALSE;
4132 *locsymsp = locsyms;
4133 }
4134 sym = locsyms + r_symndx;
4135
4136 if (hp != NULL)
4137 *hp = NULL;
4138
4139 if (symp != NULL)
4140 *symp = sym;
4141
4142 if (symsecp != NULL)
4143 *symsecp = bfd_section_from_elf_index (ibfd, sym->st_shndx);
4144
4145 if (tls_maskp != NULL)
4146 {
4147 bfd_signed_vma *local_got;
4148 unsigned char *tls_mask;
4149
4150 tls_mask = NULL;
4151 local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
4152 if (local_got != NULL)
4153 {
4154 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
4155 (local_got + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4156 unsigned char *lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
4157 (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4158 tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
4159 }
4160 *tls_maskp = tls_mask;
4161 }
4162 }
4163 return TRUE;
4164 }
4165 \f
4166 /* Analyze inline PLT call relocations to see whether calls to locally
4167 defined functions can be converted to direct calls. */
4168
4169 bfd_boolean
4170 ppc_elf_inline_plt (struct bfd_link_info *info)
4171 {
4172 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4173 bfd *ibfd;
4174 asection *sec;
4175 bfd_vma low_vma, high_vma, limit;
4176
4177 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4178 if (htab == NULL)
4179 return FALSE;
4180
4181 /* A bl insn can reach -0x2000000 to 0x1fffffc. The limit is
4182 reduced somewhat to cater for possible stubs that might be added
4183 between the call and its destination. */
4184 limit = 0x1e00000;
4185 low_vma = -1;
4186 high_vma = 0;
4187 for (sec = info->output_bfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4188 if ((sec->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE)) == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE))
4189 {
4190 if (low_vma > sec->vma)
4191 low_vma = sec->vma;
4192 if (high_vma < sec->vma + sec->size)
4193 high_vma = sec->vma + sec->size;
4194 }
4195
4196 /* If a "bl" can reach anywhere in local code sections, then we can
4197 convert all inline PLT sequences to direct calls when the symbol
4198 is local. */
4199 if (high_vma - low_vma < limit)
4200 {
4201 htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt = 1;
4202 return TRUE;
4203 }
4204
4205 /* Otherwise, go looking through relocs for cases where a direct
4206 call won't reach. Mark the symbol on any such reloc to disable
4207 the optimization and keep the PLT entry as it seems likely that
4208 this will be better than creating trampolines. Note that this
4209 will disable the optimization for all inline PLT calls to a
4210 particular symbol, not just those that won't reach. The
4211 difficulty in doing a more precise optimization is that the
4212 linker needs to make a decision depending on whether a
4213 particular R_PPC_PLTCALL insn can be turned into a direct
4214 call, for each of the R_PPC_PLTSEQ and R_PPC_PLT16* insns in
4215 the sequence, and there is nothing that ties those relocs
4216 together except their symbol. */
4217
4218 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4219 {
4220 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
4221 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
4222
4223 if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
4224 continue;
4225
4226 local_syms = NULL;
4227 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4228
4229 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4230 if (sec->has_pltcall
4231 && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
4232 {
4233 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
4234
4235 /* Read the relocations. */
4236 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
4237 info->keep_memory);
4238 if (relstart == NULL)
4239 return FALSE;
4240
4241 relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
4242 for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; )
4243 {
4244 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
4245 unsigned long r_symndx;
4246 asection *sym_sec;
4247 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4248 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
4249 unsigned char *tls_maskp;
4250
4251 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4252 if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTCALL)
4253 continue;
4254
4255 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4256 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, &tls_maskp, &local_syms,
4257 r_symndx, ibfd))
4258 {
4259 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4260 free (relstart);
4261 if (local_syms != NULL
4262 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
4263 free (local_syms);
4264 return FALSE;
4265 }
4266
4267 if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
4268 {
4269 bfd_vma from, to;
4270 if (h != NULL)
4271 to = h->root.u.def.value;
4272 else
4273 to = sym->st_value;
4274 to += (rel->r_addend
4275 + sym_sec->output_offset
4276 + sym_sec->output_section->vma);
4277 from = (rel->r_offset
4278 + sec->output_offset
4279 + sec->output_section->vma);
4280 if (to - from + limit < 2 * limit)
4281 *tls_maskp &= ~PLT_KEEP;
4282 }
4283 }
4284 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4285 free (relstart);
4286 }
4287
4288 if (local_syms != NULL
4289 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
4290 {
4291 if (!info->keep_memory)
4292 free (local_syms);
4293 else
4294 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
4295 }
4296 }
4297
4298 return TRUE;
4299 }
4300
4301 /* Set plt output section type, htab->tls_get_addr, and call the
4302 generic ELF tls_setup function. */
4303
4304 asection *
4305 ppc_elf_tls_setup (bfd *obfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4306 {
4307 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4308
4309 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4310 htab->tls_get_addr = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
4311 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
4312 if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
4313 htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt = TRUE;
4314
4315 if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt)
4316 {
4317 struct elf_link_hash_entry *opt, *tga;
4318 opt = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr_opt",
4319 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
4320 if (opt != NULL
4321 && (opt->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
4322 || opt->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
4323 {
4324 /* If glibc supports an optimized __tls_get_addr call stub,
4325 signalled by the presence of __tls_get_addr_opt, and we'll
4326 be calling __tls_get_addr via a plt call stub, then
4327 make __tls_get_addr point to __tls_get_addr_opt. */
4328 tga = htab->tls_get_addr;
4329 if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
4330 && tga != NULL
4331 && (tga->type == STT_FUNC
4332 || tga->needs_plt)
4333 && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, tga)
4334 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, tga)))
4335 {
4336 struct plt_entry *ent;
4337 for (ent = tga->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4338 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4339 break;
4340 if (ent != NULL)
4341 {
4342 tga->root.type = bfd_link_hash_indirect;
4343 tga->root.u.i.link = &opt->root;
4344 ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (info, opt, tga);
4345 opt->mark = 1;
4346 if (opt->dynindx != -1)
4347 {
4348 /* Use __tls_get_addr_opt in dynamic relocations. */
4349 opt->dynindx = -1;
4350 _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
4351 opt->dynstr_index);
4352 if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, opt))
4353 return FALSE;
4354 }
4355 htab->tls_get_addr = opt;
4356 }
4357 }
4358 }
4359 else
4360 htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt = TRUE;
4361 }
4362 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
4363 && htab->elf.splt != NULL
4364 && htab->elf.splt->output_section != NULL)
4365 {
4366 elf_section_type (htab->elf.splt->output_section) = SHT_PROGBITS;
4367 elf_section_flags (htab->elf.splt->output_section) = SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE;
4368 }
4369
4370 return _bfd_elf_tls_setup (obfd, info);
4371 }
4372
4373 /* Return TRUE iff REL is a branch reloc with a global symbol matching
4374 HASH. */
4375
4376 static bfd_boolean
4377 branch_reloc_hash_match (const bfd *ibfd,
4378 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
4379 const struct elf_link_hash_entry *hash)
4380 {
4381 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4382 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4383 unsigned int r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4384
4385 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
4386 {
4387 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4388 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4389
4390 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4391 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4392 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4393 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4394 if (h == hash)
4395 return TRUE;
4396 }
4397 return FALSE;
4398 }
4399
4400 /* Run through all the TLS relocs looking for optimization
4401 opportunities. */
4402
4403 bfd_boolean
4404 ppc_elf_tls_optimize (bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4405 struct bfd_link_info *info)
4406 {
4407 bfd *ibfd;
4408 asection *sec;
4409 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4410 int pass;
4411
4412 if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
4413 return TRUE;
4414
4415 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4416 if (htab == NULL)
4417 return FALSE;
4418
4419 /* Make two passes through the relocs. First time check that tls
4420 relocs involved in setting up a tls_get_addr call are indeed
4421 followed by such a call. If they are not, don't do any tls
4422 optimization. On the second pass twiddle tls_mask flags to
4423 notify relocate_section that optimization can be done, and
4424 adjust got and plt refcounts. */
4425 for (pass = 0; pass < 2; ++pass)
4426 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4427 {
4428 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4429 asection *got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, ".got2");
4430
4431 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4432 if (sec->has_tls_reloc && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
4433 {
4434 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
4435 int expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
4436
4437 /* Read the relocations. */
4438 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
4439 info->keep_memory);
4440 if (relstart == NULL)
4441 return FALSE;
4442
4443 relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
4444 for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; rel++)
4445 {
4446 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
4447 unsigned long r_symndx;
4448 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h = NULL;
4449 unsigned char *tls_mask;
4450 unsigned char tls_set, tls_clear;
4451 bfd_boolean is_local;
4452 bfd_signed_vma *got_count;
4453
4454 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4455 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4456 {
4457 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
4458
4459 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4460 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4461 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4462 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4463 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4464 }
4465
4466 is_local = FALSE;
4467 if (h == NULL
4468 || !h->def_dynamic)
4469 is_local = TRUE;
4470
4471 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4472 /* If this section has old-style __tls_get_addr calls
4473 without marker relocs, then check that each
4474 __tls_get_addr call reloc is preceded by a reloc
4475 that conceivably belongs to the __tls_get_addr arg
4476 setup insn. If we don't find matching arg setup
4477 relocs, don't do any tls optimization. */
4478 if (pass == 0
4479 && sec->has_tls_get_addr_call
4480 && h != NULL
4481 && h == htab->tls_get_addr
4482 && !expecting_tls_get_addr
4483 && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
4484 {
4485 info->callbacks->minfo ("%H __tls_get_addr lost arg, "
4486 "TLS optimization disabled\n",
4487 ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
4488 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4489 free (relstart);
4490 return TRUE;
4491 }
4492
4493 expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
4494 switch (r_type)
4495 {
4496 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
4497 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
4498 expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
4499 /* Fall through. */
4500
4501 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
4502 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
4503 /* These relocs should never be against a symbol
4504 defined in a shared lib. Leave them alone if
4505 that turns out to be the case. */
4506 if (!is_local)
4507 continue;
4508
4509 /* LD -> LE */
4510 tls_set = 0;
4511 tls_clear = TLS_LD;
4512 break;
4513
4514 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
4515 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
4516 expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
4517 /* Fall through. */
4518
4519 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
4520 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
4521 if (is_local)
4522 /* GD -> LE */
4523 tls_set = 0;
4524 else
4525 /* GD -> IE */
4526 tls_set = TLS_TLS | TLS_GDIE;
4527 tls_clear = TLS_GD;
4528 break;
4529
4530 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
4531 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
4532 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
4533 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
4534 if (is_local)
4535 {
4536 /* IE -> LE */
4537 tls_set = 0;
4538 tls_clear = TLS_TPREL;
4539 break;
4540 }
4541 else
4542 continue;
4543
4544 case R_PPC_TLSGD:
4545 case R_PPC_TLSLD:
4546 if (rel + 1 < relend
4547 && is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
4548 {
4549 if (pass != 0
4550 && ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) != R_PPC_PLTSEQ)
4551 {
4552 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info);
4553 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel[1].r_info);
4554 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4555 {
4556 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
4557
4558 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4559 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4560 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4561 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4562 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4563 if (h != NULL)
4564 {
4565 struct plt_entry *ent = NULL;
4566 bfd_vma addend = 0;
4567
4568 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4569 addend = rel->r_addend;
4570 ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist,
4571 got2, addend);
4572 if (ent != NULL
4573 && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4574 ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
4575 }
4576 }
4577 }
4578 continue;
4579 }
4580 expecting_tls_get_addr = 2;
4581 tls_set = 0;
4582 tls_clear = 0;
4583 break;
4584
4585 default:
4586 continue;
4587 }
4588
4589 if (pass == 0)
4590 {
4591 if (!expecting_tls_get_addr
4592 || !sec->has_tls_get_addr_call)
4593 continue;
4594
4595 if (rel + 1 < relend
4596 && branch_reloc_hash_match (ibfd, rel + 1,
4597 htab->tls_get_addr))
4598 continue;
4599
4600 /* Uh oh, we didn't find the expected call. We
4601 could just mark this symbol to exclude it
4602 from tls optimization but it's safer to skip
4603 the entire optimization. */
4604 info->callbacks->minfo (_("%H arg lost __tls_get_addr, "
4605 "TLS optimization disabled\n"),
4606 ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
4607 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4608 free (relstart);
4609 return TRUE;
4610 }
4611
4612 if (h != NULL)
4613 {
4614 tls_mask = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask;
4615 got_count = &h->got.refcount;
4616 }
4617 else
4618 {
4619 bfd_signed_vma *lgot_refs;
4620 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
4621 unsigned char *lgot_masks;
4622
4623 lgot_refs = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
4624 if (lgot_refs == NULL)
4625 abort ();
4626 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
4627 (lgot_refs + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4628 lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
4629 (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4630 tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
4631 got_count = &lgot_refs[r_symndx];
4632 }
4633
4634 /* If we don't have old-style __tls_get_addr calls
4635 without TLSGD/TLSLD marker relocs, and we haven't
4636 found a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a
4637 marker for this symbol, then we either have a
4638 broken object file or an -mlongcall style
4639 indirect call to __tls_get_addr without a marker.
4640 Disable optimization in this case. */
4641 if ((tls_clear & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD)) != 0
4642 && !sec->has_tls_get_addr_call
4643 && ((*tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
4644 != (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK)))
4645 continue;
4646
4647 if (expecting_tls_get_addr)
4648 {
4649 struct plt_entry *ent;
4650 bfd_vma addend = 0;
4651
4652 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
4653 && (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC_PLTREL24
4654 || ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC_PLTCALL))
4655 addend = rel[1].r_addend;
4656 ent = find_plt_ent (&htab->tls_get_addr->plt.plist,
4657 got2, addend);
4658 if (ent != NULL && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4659 ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
4660
4661 if (expecting_tls_get_addr == 2)
4662 continue;
4663 }
4664
4665 if (tls_set == 0)
4666 {
4667 /* We managed to get rid of a got entry. */
4668 if (*got_count > 0)
4669 *got_count -= 1;
4670 }
4671
4672 *tls_mask |= tls_set;
4673 *tls_mask &= ~tls_clear;
4674 }
4675
4676 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4677 free (relstart);
4678 }
4679 }
4680 htab->do_tls_opt = 1;
4681 return TRUE;
4682 }
4683 \f
4684 /* Find dynamic relocs for H that apply to read-only sections. */
4685
4686 static asection *
4687 readonly_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4688 {
4689 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
4690
4691 for (p = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
4692 {
4693 asection *s = p->sec->output_section;
4694
4695 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
4696 return p->sec;
4697 }
4698 return NULL;
4699 }
4700
4701 /* Return true if we have dynamic relocs against H or any of its weak
4702 aliases, that apply to read-only sections. Cannot be used after
4703 size_dynamic_sections. */
4704
4705 static bfd_boolean
4706 alias_readonly_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4707 {
4708 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
4709 do
4710 {
4711 if (readonly_dynrelocs (&eh->elf))
4712 return TRUE;
4713 eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (eh->elf.u.alias);
4714 } while (eh != NULL && &eh->elf != h);
4715
4716 return FALSE;
4717 }
4718
4719 /* Return whether H has pc-relative dynamic relocs. */
4720
4721 static bfd_boolean
4722 pc_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4723 {
4724 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
4725
4726 for (p = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
4727 if (p->pc_count != 0)
4728 return TRUE;
4729 return FALSE;
4730 }
4731
4732 /* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a
4733 regular object. The current definition is in some section of the
4734 dynamic object, but we're not including those sections. We have to
4735 change the definition to something the rest of the link can
4736 understand. */
4737
4738 static bfd_boolean
4739 ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
4740 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4741 {
4742 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4743 asection *s;
4744
4745 #ifdef DEBUG
4746 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol called for %s\n",
4747 h->root.root.string);
4748 #endif
4749
4750 /* Make sure we know what is going on here. */
4751 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4752 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.dynobj != NULL
4753 && (h->needs_plt
4754 || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
4755 || h->is_weakalias
4756 || (h->def_dynamic
4757 && h->ref_regular
4758 && !h->def_regular)));
4759
4760 /* Deal with function syms. */
4761 if (h->type == STT_FUNC
4762 || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
4763 || h->needs_plt)
4764 {
4765 bfd_boolean local = (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
4766 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h));
4767 /* Discard dyn_relocs when non-pic if we've decided that a
4768 function symbol is local. */
4769 if (!bfd_link_pic (info) && local)
4770 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4771
4772 /* Clear procedure linkage table information for any symbol that
4773 won't need a .plt entry. */
4774 struct plt_entry *ent;
4775 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4776 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4777 break;
4778 if (ent == NULL
4779 || (h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC
4780 && local
4781 && (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
4782 || (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
4783 & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)))
4784 {
4785 /* A PLT entry is not required/allowed when:
4786
4787 1. We are not using ld.so; because then the PLT entry
4788 can't be set up, so we can't use one. In this case,
4789 ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol won't even be called.
4790
4791 2. GC has rendered the entry unused.
4792
4793 3. We know for certain that a call to this symbol
4794 will go to this object, or will remain undefined. */
4795 h->plt.plist = NULL;
4796 h->needs_plt = 0;
4797 h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
4798 }
4799 else
4800 {
4801 /* Taking a function's address in a read/write section
4802 doesn't require us to define the function symbol in the
4803 executable on a plt call stub. A dynamic reloc can
4804 be used instead, giving better runtime performance.
4805 (Calls via that function pointer don't need to bounce
4806 through the plt call stub.) Similarly, use a dynamic
4807 reloc for a weak reference when possible, allowing the
4808 resolution of the symbol to be set at load time rather
4809 than link time. */
4810 if ((h->pointer_equality_needed
4811 || (h->non_got_ref
4812 && !h->ref_regular_nonweak
4813 && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)))
4814 && !htab->is_vxworks
4815 && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs
4816 && !readonly_dynrelocs (h))
4817 {
4818 h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
4819 /* If we haven't seen a branch reloc and the symbol
4820 isn't an ifunc then we don't need a plt entry. */
4821 if (!h->needs_plt && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
4822 h->plt.plist = NULL;
4823 }
4824 else if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
4825 /* We are going to be defining the function symbol on the
4826 plt stub, so no dyn_relocs needed when non-pic. */
4827 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4828 }
4829 h->protected_def = 0;
4830 /* Function symbols can't have copy relocs. */
4831 return TRUE;
4832 }
4833 else
4834 h->plt.plist = NULL;
4835
4836 /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
4837 processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
4838 real definition first, and we can just use the same value. */
4839 if (h->is_weakalias)
4840 {
4841 struct elf_link_hash_entry *def = weakdef (h);
4842 BFD_ASSERT (def->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined);
4843 h->root.u.def.section = def->root.u.def.section;
4844 h->root.u.def.value = def->root.u.def.value;
4845 if (def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynbss
4846 || def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro
4847 || def->root.u.def.section == htab->dynsbss)
4848 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4849 return TRUE;
4850 }
4851
4852 /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object which
4853 is not a function. */
4854
4855 /* If we are creating a shared library, we must presume that the
4856 only references to the symbol are via the global offset table.
4857 For such cases we need not do anything here; the relocations will
4858 be handled correctly by relocate_section. */
4859 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4860 {
4861 h->protected_def = 0;
4862 return TRUE;
4863 }
4864
4865 /* If there are no references to this symbol that do not use the
4866 GOT, we don't need to generate a copy reloc. */
4867 if (!h->non_got_ref)
4868 {
4869 h->protected_def = 0;
4870 return TRUE;
4871 }
4872
4873 /* Protected variables do not work with .dynbss. The copy in
4874 .dynbss won't be used by the shared library with the protected
4875 definition for the variable. Editing to PIC, or text relocations
4876 are preferable to an incorrect program. */
4877 if (h->protected_def)
4878 {
4879 if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
4880 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
4881 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo
4882 && htab->params->pic_fixup == 0
4883 && info->disable_target_specific_optimizations <= 1)
4884 htab->params->pic_fixup = 1;
4885 return TRUE;
4886 }
4887
4888 /* If -z nocopyreloc was given, we won't generate them either. */
4889 if (info->nocopyreloc)
4890 return TRUE;
4891
4892 /* If we don't find any dynamic relocs in read-only sections, then
4893 we'll be keeping the dynamic relocs and avoiding the copy reloc.
4894 We can't do this if there are any small data relocations. This
4895 doesn't work on VxWorks, where we can not have dynamic
4896 relocations (other than copy and jump slot relocations) in an
4897 executable. */
4898 if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
4899 && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs
4900 && !htab->is_vxworks
4901 && !h->def_regular
4902 && !alias_readonly_dynrelocs (h))
4903 return TRUE;
4904
4905 /* We must allocate the symbol in our .dynbss section, which will
4906 become part of the .bss section of the executable. There will be
4907 an entry for this symbol in the .dynsym section. The dynamic
4908 object will contain position independent code, so all references
4909 from the dynamic object to this symbol will go through the global
4910 offset table. The dynamic linker will use the .dynsym entry to
4911 determine the address it must put in the global offset table, so
4912 both the dynamic object and the regular object will refer to the
4913 same memory location for the variable.
4914
4915 Of course, if the symbol is referenced using SDAREL relocs, we
4916 must instead allocate it in .sbss. */
4917 if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
4918 s = htab->dynsbss;
4919 else if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
4920 s = htab->elf.sdynrelro;
4921 else
4922 s = htab->elf.sdynbss;
4923 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
4924
4925 if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0 && h->size != 0)
4926 {
4927 asection *srel;
4928
4929 /* We must generate a R_PPC_COPY reloc to tell the dynamic
4930 linker to copy the initial value out of the dynamic object
4931 and into the runtime process image. */
4932 if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
4933 srel = htab->relsbss;
4934 else if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
4935 srel = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
4936 else
4937 srel = htab->elf.srelbss;
4938 BFD_ASSERT (srel != NULL);
4939 srel->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
4940 h->needs_copy = 1;
4941 }
4942
4943 /* We no longer want dyn_relocs. */
4944 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4945 return _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_copy (info, h, s);
4946 }
4947 \f
4948 /* Generate a symbol to mark plt call stubs. For non-PIC code the sym is
4949 xxxxxxxx.plt_call32.<callee> where xxxxxxxx is a hex number, usually 0,
4950 specifying the addend on the plt relocation. For -fpic code, the sym
4951 is xxxxxxxx.plt_pic32.<callee>, and for -fPIC
4952 xxxxxxxx.got2.plt_pic32.<callee>. */
4953
4954 static bfd_boolean
4955 add_stub_sym (struct plt_entry *ent,
4956 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4957 struct bfd_link_info *info)
4958 {
4959 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sh;
4960 size_t len1, len2, len3;
4961 char *name;
4962 const char *stub;
4963 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4964
4965 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4966 stub = ".plt_pic32.";
4967 else
4968 stub = ".plt_call32.";
4969
4970 len1 = strlen (h->root.root.string);
4971 len2 = strlen (stub);
4972 len3 = 0;
4973 if (ent->sec)
4974 len3 = strlen (ent->sec->name);
4975 name = bfd_malloc (len1 + len2 + len3 + 9);
4976 if (name == NULL)
4977 return FALSE;
4978 sprintf (name, "%08x", (unsigned) ent->addend & 0xffffffff);
4979 if (ent->sec)
4980 memcpy (name + 8, ent->sec->name, len3);
4981 memcpy (name + 8 + len3, stub, len2);
4982 memcpy (name + 8 + len3 + len2, h->root.root.string, len1 + 1);
4983 sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, name, TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
4984 if (sh == NULL)
4985 return FALSE;
4986 if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
4987 {
4988 sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
4989 sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
4990 sh->root.u.def.value = ent->glink_offset;
4991 sh->ref_regular = 1;
4992 sh->def_regular = 1;
4993 sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
4994 sh->forced_local = 1;
4995 sh->non_elf = 0;
4996 sh->root.linker_def = 1;
4997 }
4998 return TRUE;
4999 }
5000
5001 /* Allocate NEED contiguous space in .got, and return the offset.
5002 Handles allocation of the got header when crossing 32k. */
5003
5004 static bfd_vma
5005 allocate_got (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab, unsigned int need)
5006 {
5007 bfd_vma where;
5008 unsigned int max_before_header;
5009
5010 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
5011 {
5012 where = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5013 htab->elf.sgot->size += need;
5014 }
5015 else
5016 {
5017 max_before_header = htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW ? 32768 : 32764;
5018 if (need <= htab->got_gap)
5019 {
5020 where = max_before_header - htab->got_gap;
5021 htab->got_gap -= need;
5022 }
5023 else
5024 {
5025 if (htab->elf.sgot->size + need > max_before_header
5026 && htab->elf.sgot->size <= max_before_header)
5027 {
5028 htab->got_gap = max_before_header - htab->elf.sgot->size;
5029 htab->elf.sgot->size = max_before_header + htab->got_header_size;
5030 }
5031 where = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5032 htab->elf.sgot->size += need;
5033 }
5034 }
5035 return where;
5036 }
5037
5038 /* Calculate size of GOT entries for symbol given its TLS_MASK.
5039 TLS_LD is excluded because those go in a special GOT slot. */
5040
5041 static inline unsigned int
5042 got_entries_needed (int tls_mask)
5043 {
5044 unsigned int need;
5045 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) == 0)
5046 need = 4;
5047 else
5048 {
5049 need = 0;
5050 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) != 0)
5051 need += 8;
5052 if ((tls_mask & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)) != 0)
5053 need += 4;
5054 if ((tls_mask & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
5055 need += 4;
5056 }
5057 return need;
5058 }
5059
5060 /* Calculate size of relocs needed for symbol given its TLS_MASK and
5061 NEEDed GOT entries. KNOWN says a TPREL offset can be calculated at
5062 link time. */
5063
5064 static inline unsigned int
5065 got_relocs_needed (int tls_mask, unsigned int need, bfd_boolean known)
5066 {
5067 /* All the entries we allocated need relocs.
5068 Except IE in executable with a local symbol. We could also omit
5069 the DTPREL reloc on the second word of a GD entry under the same
5070 condition as that for IE, but ld.so needs to differentiate
5071 LD and GD entries. */
5072 if (known && (tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
5073 && (tls_mask & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)) != 0)
5074 need -= 4;
5075 return need * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4;
5076 }
5077
5078 /* If H is undefined, make it dynamic if that makes sense. */
5079
5080 static bfd_boolean
5081 ensure_undef_dynamic (struct bfd_link_info *info,
5082 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
5083 {
5084 struct elf_link_hash_table *htab = elf_hash_table (info);
5085
5086 if (htab->dynamic_sections_created
5087 && ((info->dynamic_undefined_weak != 0
5088 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
5089 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
5090 && h->dynindx == -1
5091 && !h->forced_local
5092 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT)
5093 return bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h);
5094 return TRUE;
5095 }
5096
5097 /* Allocate space in associated reloc sections for dynamic relocs. */
5098
5099 static bfd_boolean
5100 allocate_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
5101 {
5102 struct bfd_link_info *info = inf;
5103 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
5104 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
5105 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
5106 bfd_boolean dyn;
5107
5108 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
5109 return TRUE;
5110
5111 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
5112 eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
5113 if (eh->elf.got.refcount > 0
5114 || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
5115 && !eh->elf.def_regular
5116 && eh->elf.protected_def
5117 && eh->has_addr16_ha
5118 && eh->has_addr16_lo
5119 && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0))
5120 {
5121 unsigned int need;
5122
5123 /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */
5124 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, &eh->elf))
5125 return FALSE;
5126
5127 need = 0;
5128 if ((eh->tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5129 {
5130 if (!eh->elf.def_dynamic)
5131 /* We'll just use htab->tlsld_got.offset. This should
5132 always be the case. It's a little odd if we have
5133 a local dynamic reloc against a non-local symbol. */
5134 htab->tlsld_got.refcount += 1;
5135 else
5136 need += 8;
5137 }
5138 need += got_entries_needed (eh->tls_mask);
5139 if (need == 0)
5140 eh->elf.got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5141 else
5142 {
5143 eh->elf.got.offset = allocate_got (htab, need);
5144 if ((bfd_link_pic (info)
5145 || (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5146 && eh->elf.dynindx != -1
5147 && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf)))
5148 && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, &eh->elf))
5149 {
5150 asection *rsec;
5151 bfd_boolean tprel_known = (bfd_link_executable (info)
5152 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info,
5153 &eh->elf));
5154
5155 need = got_relocs_needed (eh->tls_mask, need, tprel_known);
5156 if ((eh->tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)
5157 && eh->elf.def_dynamic)
5158 need -= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5159 rsec = htab->elf.srelgot;
5160 if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5161 rsec = htab->elf.irelplt;
5162 rsec->size += need;
5163 }
5164 }
5165 }
5166 else
5167 eh->elf.got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5168
5169 /* If no dynamic sections we can't have dynamic relocs, except for
5170 IFUNCs which are handled even in static executables. */
5171 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5172 && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5173 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5174
5175 /* Discard relocs on undefined symbols that must be local. */
5176 else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
5177 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_DEFAULT)
5178 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5179
5180 /* Also discard relocs on undefined weak syms with non-default
5181 visibility, or when dynamic_undefined_weak says so. */
5182 else if (UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
5183 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5184
5185 if (eh->dyn_relocs == NULL)
5186 ;
5187
5188 /* In the shared -Bsymbolic case, discard space allocated for
5189 dynamic pc-relative relocs against symbols which turn out to be
5190 defined in regular objects. For the normal shared case, discard
5191 space for relocs that have become local due to symbol visibility
5192 changes. */
5193 else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5194 {
5195 /* Relocs that use pc_count are those that appear on a call insn,
5196 or certain REL relocs (see must_be_dyn_reloc) that can be
5197 generated via assembly. We want calls to protected symbols to
5198 resolve directly to the function rather than going via the plt.
5199 If people want function pointer comparisons to work as expected
5200 then they should avoid writing weird assembly. */
5201 if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h))
5202 {
5203 struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
5204
5205 for (pp = &eh->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
5206 {
5207 p->count -= p->pc_count;
5208 p->pc_count = 0;
5209 if (p->count == 0)
5210 *pp = p->next;
5211 else
5212 pp = &p->next;
5213 }
5214 }
5215
5216 if (htab->is_vxworks)
5217 {
5218 struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
5219
5220 for (pp = &eh->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
5221 {
5222 if (strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name, ".tls_vars") == 0)
5223 *pp = p->next;
5224 else
5225 pp = &p->next;
5226 }
5227 }
5228
5229 if (eh->dyn_relocs != NULL)
5230 {
5231 /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */
5232 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
5233 return FALSE;
5234 }
5235 }
5236 else if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS)
5237 {
5238 /* For the non-pic case, discard space for relocs against
5239 symbols which turn out to need copy relocs or are not
5240 dynamic. */
5241 if (h->dynamic_adjusted
5242 && !h->def_regular
5243 && !ELF_COMMON_DEF_P (h)
5244 && !(h->protected_def
5245 && eh->has_addr16_ha
5246 && eh->has_addr16_lo
5247 && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0))
5248 {
5249 /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */
5250 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
5251 return FALSE;
5252
5253 if (h->dynindx == -1)
5254 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5255 }
5256 else
5257 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5258 }
5259
5260 /* Allocate space. */
5261 for (p = eh->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
5262 {
5263 asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
5264 if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5265 sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
5266 sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5267 }
5268
5269 /* Handle PLT relocs. Done last, after dynindx has settled.
5270 We might need a PLT entry when the symbol
5271 a) is dynamic, or
5272 b) is an ifunc, or
5273 c) has plt16 relocs and has been processed by adjust_dynamic_symbol, or
5274 d) has plt16 relocs and we are linking statically. */
5275 dyn = htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created && h->dynindx != -1;
5276 if (dyn
5277 || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
5278 || (h->needs_plt && h->dynamic_adjusted)
5279 || (h->needs_plt
5280 && h->def_regular
5281 && !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5282 && !htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
5283 && (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
5284 & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) == PLT_KEEP))
5285 {
5286 struct plt_entry *ent;
5287 bfd_boolean doneone = FALSE;
5288 bfd_vma plt_offset = 0, glink_offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5289
5290 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
5291 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
5292 {
5293 asection *s = htab->elf.splt;
5294
5295 if (!dyn)
5296 {
5297 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5298 s = htab->elf.iplt;
5299 else
5300 s = htab->pltlocal;
5301 }
5302
5303 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW || !dyn)
5304 {
5305 if (!doneone)
5306 {
5307 plt_offset = s->size;
5308 s->size += 4;
5309 }
5310 ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5311
5312 if (s == htab->pltlocal)
5313 ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5314 else
5315 {
5316 s = htab->glink;
5317 if (!doneone || bfd_link_pic (info))
5318 {
5319 glink_offset = s->size;
5320 s->size += GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, h);
5321 }
5322 if (!doneone
5323 && !bfd_link_pic (info)
5324 && h->def_dynamic
5325 && !h->def_regular)
5326 {
5327 h->root.u.def.section = s;
5328 h->root.u.def.value = glink_offset;
5329 }
5330 ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5331
5332 if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms
5333 && !add_stub_sym (ent, h, info))
5334 return FALSE;
5335 }
5336 }
5337 else
5338 {
5339 if (!doneone)
5340 {
5341 /* If this is the first .plt entry, make room
5342 for the special first entry. */
5343 if (s->size == 0)
5344 s->size += htab->plt_initial_entry_size;
5345
5346 /* The PowerPC PLT is actually composed of two
5347 parts, the first part is 2 words (for a load
5348 and a jump), and then there is a remaining
5349 word available at the end. */
5350 plt_offset = (htab->plt_initial_entry_size
5351 + (htab->plt_slot_size
5352 * ((s->size
5353 - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5354 / htab->plt_entry_size)));
5355
5356 /* If this symbol is not defined in a regular
5357 file, and we are not generating a shared
5358 library, then set the symbol to this location
5359 in the .plt. This is to avoid text
5360 relocations, and is required to make
5361 function pointers compare as equal between
5362 the normal executable and the shared library. */
5363 if (! bfd_link_pic (info)
5364 && h->def_dynamic
5365 && !h->def_regular)
5366 {
5367 h->root.u.def.section = s;
5368 h->root.u.def.value = plt_offset;
5369 }
5370
5371 /* Make room for this entry. */
5372 s->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
5373 /* After the 8192nd entry, room for two entries
5374 is allocated. */
5375 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD
5376 && (s->size - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5377 / htab->plt_entry_size
5378 > PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES)
5379 s->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
5380 }
5381 ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5382 }
5383
5384 /* We also need to make an entry in the .rela.plt section. */
5385 if (!doneone)
5386 {
5387 if (!dyn)
5388 {
5389 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5390 {
5391 s = htab->elf.irelplt;
5392 s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5393 }
5394 else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5395 {
5396 s = htab->relpltlocal;
5397 s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5398 }
5399 }
5400 else
5401 {
5402 htab->elf.srelplt->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5403
5404 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
5405 {
5406 /* Allocate space for the unloaded relocations. */
5407 if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
5408 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5409 {
5410 if (ent->plt.offset
5411 == (bfd_vma) htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5412 {
5413 htab->srelplt2->size
5414 += (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
5415 * VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS);
5416 }
5417
5418 htab->srelplt2->size
5419 += (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
5420 * VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS);
5421 }
5422
5423 /* Every PLT entry has an associated GOT entry in
5424 .got.plt. */
5425 htab->elf.sgotplt->size += 4;
5426 }
5427 }
5428 doneone = TRUE;
5429 }
5430 }
5431 else
5432 ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5433
5434 if (!doneone)
5435 {
5436 h->plt.plist = NULL;
5437 h->needs_plt = 0;
5438 }
5439 }
5440 else
5441 {
5442 h->plt.plist = NULL;
5443 h->needs_plt = 0;
5444 }
5445
5446 return TRUE;
5447 }
5448
5449 /* Set DF_TEXTREL if we find any dynamic relocs that apply to
5450 read-only sections. */
5451
5452 static bfd_boolean
5453 maybe_set_textrel (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *info_p)
5454 {
5455 asection *sec;
5456
5457 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
5458 return TRUE;
5459
5460 sec = readonly_dynrelocs (h);
5461 if (sec != NULL)
5462 {
5463 struct bfd_link_info *info = (struct bfd_link_info *) info_p;
5464
5465 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
5466 info->callbacks->minfo
5467 (_("%pB: dynamic relocation against `%pT' in read-only section `%pA'\n"),
5468 sec->owner, h->root.root.string, sec);
5469
5470 /* Not an error, just cut short the traversal. */
5471 return FALSE;
5472 }
5473 return TRUE;
5474 }
5475
5476 static const unsigned char glink_eh_frame_cie[] =
5477 {
5478 0, 0, 0, 16, /* length. */
5479 0, 0, 0, 0, /* id. */
5480 1, /* CIE version. */
5481 'z', 'R', 0, /* Augmentation string. */
5482 4, /* Code alignment. */
5483 0x7c, /* Data alignment. */
5484 65, /* RA reg. */
5485 1, /* Augmentation size. */
5486 DW_EH_PE_pcrel | DW_EH_PE_sdata4, /* FDE encoding. */
5487 DW_CFA_def_cfa, 1, 0 /* def_cfa: r1 offset 0. */
5488 };
5489
5490 /* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections. */
5491
5492 static bfd_boolean
5493 ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
5494 struct bfd_link_info *info)
5495 {
5496 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
5497 asection *s;
5498 bfd_boolean relocs;
5499 bfd *ibfd;
5500
5501 #ifdef DEBUG
5502 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections called\n");
5503 #endif
5504
5505 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
5506 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.dynobj != NULL);
5507
5508 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
5509 {
5510 /* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter. */
5511 if (bfd_link_executable (info) && !info->nointerp)
5512 {
5513 s = bfd_get_linker_section (htab->elf.dynobj, ".interp");
5514 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
5515 s->size = sizeof ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
5516 s->contents = (unsigned char *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
5517 }
5518 }
5519
5520 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
5521 htab->got_header_size = 16;
5522 else if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
5523 htab->got_header_size = 12;
5524
5525 /* Set up .got offsets for local syms, and space for local dynamic
5526 relocs. */
5527 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
5528 {
5529 bfd_signed_vma *local_got;
5530 bfd_signed_vma *end_local_got;
5531 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
5532 struct plt_entry **end_local_plt;
5533 char *lgot_masks;
5534 bfd_size_type locsymcount;
5535 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
5536
5537 if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
5538 continue;
5539
5540 for (s = ibfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
5541 {
5542 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
5543
5544 for (p = ((struct ppc_dyn_relocs *)
5545 elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel);
5546 p != NULL;
5547 p = p->next)
5548 {
5549 if (!bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec)
5550 && bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec->output_section))
5551 {
5552 /* Input section has been discarded, either because
5553 it is a copy of a linkonce section or due to
5554 linker script /DISCARD/, so we'll be discarding
5555 the relocs too. */
5556 }
5557 else if (htab->is_vxworks
5558 && strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name,
5559 ".tls_vars") == 0)
5560 {
5561 /* Relocations in vxworks .tls_vars sections are
5562 handled specially by the loader. */
5563 }
5564 else if (p->count != 0)
5565 {
5566 asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
5567 if (p->ifunc)
5568 sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
5569 sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5570 if ((p->sec->output_section->flags
5571 & (SEC_READONLY | SEC_ALLOC))
5572 == (SEC_READONLY | SEC_ALLOC))
5573 {
5574 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
5575 info->callbacks->minfo (_("%pB: dynamic relocation in read-only section `%pA'\n"),
5576 p->sec->owner, p->sec);
5577 }
5578 }
5579 }
5580 }
5581
5582 local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
5583 if (!local_got)
5584 continue;
5585
5586 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
5587 locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
5588 end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount;
5589 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_local_got;
5590 end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
5591 lgot_masks = (char *) end_local_plt;
5592
5593 for (; local_got < end_local_got; ++local_got, ++lgot_masks)
5594 if (*local_got > 0)
5595 {
5596 unsigned int need;
5597 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5598 htab->tlsld_got.refcount += 1;
5599 need = got_entries_needed (*lgot_masks);
5600 if (need == 0)
5601 *local_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
5602 else
5603 {
5604 *local_got = allocate_got (htab, need);
5605 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5606 {
5607 asection *srel;
5608 bfd_boolean tprel_known = bfd_link_executable (info);
5609
5610 need = got_relocs_needed (*lgot_masks, need, tprel_known);
5611 srel = htab->elf.srelgot;
5612 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5613 srel = htab->elf.irelplt;
5614 srel->size += need;
5615 }
5616 }
5617 }
5618 else
5619 *local_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
5620
5621 if (htab->is_vxworks)
5622 continue;
5623
5624 /* Allocate space for calls to local STT_GNU_IFUNC syms in .iplt. */
5625 lgot_masks = (char *) end_local_plt;
5626 for (; local_plt < end_local_plt; ++local_plt, ++lgot_masks)
5627 {
5628 struct plt_entry *ent;
5629 bfd_boolean doneone = FALSE;
5630 bfd_vma plt_offset = 0, glink_offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5631
5632 for (ent = *local_plt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
5633 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
5634 {
5635 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5636 s = htab->elf.iplt;
5637 else if (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
5638 || (*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)
5639 {
5640 ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5641 continue;
5642 }
5643 else
5644 s = htab->pltlocal;
5645
5646 if (!doneone)
5647 {
5648 plt_offset = s->size;
5649 s->size += 4;
5650 }
5651 ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5652
5653 if (s != htab->pltlocal && (!doneone || bfd_link_pic (info)))
5654 {
5655 s = htab->glink;
5656 glink_offset = s->size;
5657 s->size += GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, NULL);
5658 }
5659 ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5660
5661 if (!doneone)
5662 {
5663 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5664 {
5665 s = htab->elf.irelplt;
5666 s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5667 }
5668 else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5669 {
5670 s = htab->relpltlocal;
5671 s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5672 }
5673 doneone = TRUE;
5674 }
5675 }
5676 else
5677 ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5678 }
5679 }
5680
5681 /* Allocate space for global sym dynamic relocs. */
5682 elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info), allocate_dynrelocs, info);
5683
5684 if (htab->tlsld_got.refcount > 0)
5685 {
5686 htab->tlsld_got.offset = allocate_got (htab, 8);
5687 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5688 htab->elf.srelgot->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5689 }
5690 else
5691 htab->tlsld_got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5692
5693 if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL && htab->plt_type != PLT_VXWORKS)
5694 {
5695 unsigned int g_o_t = 32768;
5696
5697 /* If we haven't allocated the header, do so now. When we get here,
5698 for old plt/got the got size will be 0 to 32764 (not allocated),
5699 or 32780 to 65536 (header allocated). For new plt/got, the
5700 corresponding ranges are 0 to 32768 and 32780 to 65536. */
5701 if (htab->elf.sgot->size <= 32768)
5702 {
5703 g_o_t = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5704 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
5705 g_o_t += 4;
5706 htab->elf.sgot->size += htab->got_header_size;
5707 }
5708
5709 htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value = g_o_t;
5710 }
5711 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5712 {
5713 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
5714
5715 sda->root.u.def.section = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section;
5716 sda->root.u.def.value = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value;
5717 }
5718 if (info->emitrelocations)
5719 {
5720 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
5721
5722 if (sda != NULL && sda->ref_regular)
5723 sda->root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5724 sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
5725 if (sda != NULL && sda->ref_regular)
5726 sda->root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5727 }
5728
5729 if (htab->glink != NULL
5730 && htab->glink->size != 0
5731 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5732 {
5733 htab->glink_pltresolve = htab->glink->size;
5734 /* Space for the branch table. */
5735 htab->glink->size
5736 += htab->elf.srelplt->size / (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4) - 4;
5737 /* Pad out to align the start of PLTresolve. */
5738 htab->glink->size += -htab->glink->size & (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
5739 ? 63 : 15);
5740 htab->glink->size += GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
5741
5742 if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms)
5743 {
5744 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sh;
5745 sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink",
5746 TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
5747 if (sh == NULL)
5748 return FALSE;
5749 if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
5750 {
5751 sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5752 sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
5753 sh->root.u.def.value = htab->glink_pltresolve;
5754 sh->ref_regular = 1;
5755 sh->def_regular = 1;
5756 sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5757 sh->forced_local = 1;
5758 sh->non_elf = 0;
5759 sh->root.linker_def = 1;
5760 }
5761 sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink_PLTresolve",
5762 TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
5763 if (sh == NULL)
5764 return FALSE;
5765 if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
5766 {
5767 sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5768 sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
5769 sh->root.u.def.value = htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
5770 sh->ref_regular = 1;
5771 sh->def_regular = 1;
5772 sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5773 sh->forced_local = 1;
5774 sh->non_elf = 0;
5775 sh->root.linker_def = 1;
5776 }
5777 }
5778 }
5779
5780 if (htab->glink != NULL
5781 && htab->glink->size != 0
5782 && htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
5783 && !bfd_is_abs_section (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section)
5784 && _bfd_elf_eh_frame_present (info))
5785 {
5786 s = htab->glink_eh_frame;
5787 s->size = sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) + 20;
5788 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5789 {
5790 s->size += 4;
5791 if (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 8 >= 256)
5792 s->size += 4;
5793 }
5794 }
5795
5796 /* We've now determined the sizes of the various dynamic sections.
5797 Allocate memory for them. */
5798 relocs = FALSE;
5799 for (s = htab->elf.dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
5800 {
5801 bfd_boolean strip_section = TRUE;
5802
5803 if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
5804 continue;
5805
5806 if (s == htab->elf.splt
5807 || s == htab->elf.sgot)
5808 {
5809 /* We'd like to strip these sections if they aren't needed, but if
5810 we've exported dynamic symbols from them we must leave them.
5811 It's too late to tell BFD to get rid of the symbols. */
5812 if (htab->elf.hplt != NULL)
5813 strip_section = FALSE;
5814 /* Strip this section if we don't need it; see the
5815 comment below. */
5816 }
5817 else if (s == htab->elf.iplt
5818 || s == htab->pltlocal
5819 || s == htab->glink
5820 || s == htab->glink_eh_frame
5821 || s == htab->elf.sgotplt
5822 || s == htab->sbss
5823 || s == htab->elf.sdynbss
5824 || s == htab->elf.sdynrelro
5825 || s == htab->dynsbss)
5826 {
5827 /* Strip these too. */
5828 }
5829 else if (s == htab->sdata[0].section
5830 || s == htab->sdata[1].section)
5831 {
5832 strip_section = (s->flags & SEC_KEEP) == 0;
5833 }
5834 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (bfd_get_section_name (htab->elf.dynobj, s),
5835 ".rela"))
5836 {
5837 if (s->size != 0)
5838 {
5839 /* Remember whether there are any relocation sections. */
5840 relocs = TRUE;
5841
5842 /* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need
5843 to copy relocs into the output file. */
5844 s->reloc_count = 0;
5845 }
5846 }
5847 else
5848 {
5849 /* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space. */
5850 continue;
5851 }
5852
5853 if (s->size == 0 && strip_section)
5854 {
5855 /* If we don't need this section, strip it from the
5856 output file. This is mostly to handle .rela.bss and
5857 .rela.plt. We must create both sections in
5858 create_dynamic_sections, because they must be created
5859 before the linker maps input sections to output
5860 sections. The linker does that before
5861 adjust_dynamic_symbol is called, and it is that
5862 function which decides whether anything needs to go
5863 into these sections. */
5864 s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
5865 continue;
5866 }
5867
5868 if ((s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
5869 continue;
5870
5871 /* Allocate memory for the section contents. */
5872 s->contents = bfd_zalloc (htab->elf.dynobj, s->size);
5873 if (s->contents == NULL)
5874 return FALSE;
5875 }
5876
5877 if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5878 {
5879 /* Add some entries to the .dynamic section. We fill in the
5880 values later, in ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections, but we
5881 must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for
5882 the .dynamic section. The DT_DEBUG entry is filled in by the
5883 dynamic linker and used by the debugger. */
5884 #define add_dynamic_entry(TAG, VAL) \
5885 _bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, TAG, VAL)
5886
5887 if (bfd_link_executable (info))
5888 {
5889 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_DEBUG, 0))
5890 return FALSE;
5891 }
5892
5893 if (htab->elf.splt != NULL && htab->elf.splt->size != 0)
5894 {
5895 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTGOT, 0)
5896 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTRELSZ, 0)
5897 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTREL, DT_RELA)
5898 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_JMPREL, 0))
5899 return FALSE;
5900 }
5901
5902 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
5903 && htab->glink != NULL
5904 && htab->glink->size != 0)
5905 {
5906 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC_GOT, 0))
5907 return FALSE;
5908 if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt
5909 && htab->tls_get_addr != NULL
5910 && htab->tls_get_addr->plt.plist != NULL
5911 && !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC_OPT, PPC_OPT_TLS))
5912 return FALSE;
5913 }
5914
5915 if (relocs)
5916 {
5917 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELA, 0)
5918 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELASZ, 0)
5919 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELAENT, sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)))
5920 return FALSE;
5921 }
5922
5923 /* If any dynamic relocs apply to a read-only section, then we
5924 need a DT_TEXTREL entry. */
5925 if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) == 0)
5926 elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info), maybe_set_textrel,
5927 info);
5928
5929 if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) != 0)
5930 {
5931 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_TEXTREL, 0))
5932 return FALSE;
5933 }
5934 if (htab->is_vxworks
5935 && !elf_vxworks_add_dynamic_entries (output_bfd, info))
5936 return FALSE;
5937 }
5938 #undef add_dynamic_entry
5939
5940 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
5941 && htab->glink_eh_frame->contents != NULL)
5942 {
5943 unsigned char *p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
5944 bfd_vma val;
5945
5946 memcpy (p, glink_eh_frame_cie, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie));
5947 /* CIE length (rewrite in case little-endian). */
5948 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) - 4, p);
5949 p += sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
5950 /* FDE length. */
5951 val = htab->glink_eh_frame->size - 4 - sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
5952 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
5953 p += 4;
5954 /* CIE pointer. */
5955 val = p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
5956 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
5957 p += 4;
5958 /* Offset to .glink. Set later. */
5959 p += 4;
5960 /* .glink size. */
5961 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->glink->size, p);
5962 p += 4;
5963 /* Augmentation. */
5964 p += 1;
5965
5966 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
5967 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5968 {
5969 bfd_vma adv = (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 8) >> 2;
5970 if (adv < 64)
5971 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + adv;
5972 else if (adv < 256)
5973 {
5974 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc1;
5975 *p++ = adv;
5976 }
5977 else if (adv < 65536)
5978 {
5979 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc2;
5980 bfd_put_16 (htab->elf.dynobj, adv, p);
5981 p += 2;
5982 }
5983 else
5984 {
5985 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc4;
5986 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, adv, p);
5987 p += 4;
5988 }
5989 *p++ = DW_CFA_register;
5990 *p++ = 65;
5991 p++;
5992 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 4;
5993 *p++ = DW_CFA_restore_extended;
5994 *p++ = 65;
5995 }
5996 BFD_ASSERT ((bfd_vma) ((p + 3 - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents) & -4)
5997 == htab->glink_eh_frame->size);
5998 }
5999
6000 return TRUE;
6001 }
6002
6003 /* Arrange to have _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_ stripped from the output
6004 if it looks like nothing is using them. */
6005
6006 static void
6007 maybe_strip_sdasym (bfd *output_bfd, elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
6008 {
6009 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = lsect->sym;
6010
6011 if (sda != NULL && !sda->ref_regular && sda->dynindx == -1)
6012 {
6013 asection *s;
6014
6015 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, lsect->name);
6016 if (s == NULL || bfd_section_removed_from_list (output_bfd, s))
6017 {
6018 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, lsect->bss_name);
6019 if (s == NULL || bfd_section_removed_from_list (output_bfd, s))
6020 {
6021 sda->def_regular = 0;
6022 /* This is somewhat magic. See elf_link_output_extsym. */
6023 sda->ref_dynamic = 1;
6024 sda->forced_local = 0;
6025 }
6026 }
6027 }
6028 }
6029
6030 void
6031 ppc_elf_maybe_strip_sdata_syms (struct bfd_link_info *info)
6032 {
6033 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
6034
6035 if (htab != NULL)
6036 {
6037 maybe_strip_sdasym (info->output_bfd, &htab->sdata[0]);
6038 maybe_strip_sdasym (info->output_bfd, &htab->sdata[1]);
6039 }
6040 }
6041
6042
6043 /* Return TRUE if symbol should be hashed in the `.gnu.hash' section. */
6044
6045 static bfd_boolean
6046 ppc_elf_hash_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6047 {
6048 if (h->plt.plist != NULL
6049 && !h->def_regular
6050 && (!h->pointer_equality_needed
6051 || !h->ref_regular_nonweak))
6052 return FALSE;
6053
6054 return _bfd_elf_hash_symbol (h);
6055 }
6056 \f
6057 #define ARRAY_SIZE(a) (sizeof (a) / sizeof ((a)[0]))
6058
6059 /* Relaxation trampolines. r12 is available for clobbering (r11, is
6060 used for some functions that are allowed to break the ABI). */
6061 static const int shared_stub_entry[] =
6062 {
6063 0x7c0802a6, /* mflr 0 */
6064 0x429f0005, /* bcl 20, 31, .Lxxx */
6065 0x7d8802a6, /* mflr 12 */
6066 0x3d8c0000, /* addis 12, 12, (xxx-.Lxxx)@ha */
6067 0x398c0000, /* addi 12, 12, (xxx-.Lxxx)@l */
6068 0x7c0803a6, /* mtlr 0 */
6069 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr 12 */
6070 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
6071 };
6072
6073 static const int stub_entry[] =
6074 {
6075 0x3d800000, /* lis 12,xxx@ha */
6076 0x398c0000, /* addi 12,12,xxx@l */
6077 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr 12 */
6078 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
6079 };
6080
6081 struct ppc_elf_relax_info
6082 {
6083 unsigned int workaround_size;
6084 unsigned int picfixup_size;
6085 };
6086
6087 /* This function implements long branch trampolines, and the ppc476
6088 icache bug workaround. Any section needing trampolines or patch
6089 space for the workaround has its size extended so that we can
6090 add trampolines at the end of the section. */
6091
6092 static bfd_boolean
6093 ppc_elf_relax_section (bfd *abfd,
6094 asection *isec,
6095 struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
6096 bfd_boolean *again)
6097 {
6098 struct one_branch_fixup
6099 {
6100 struct one_branch_fixup *next;
6101 asection *tsec;
6102 /* Final link, can use the symbol offset. For a
6103 relocatable link we use the symbol's index. */
6104 bfd_vma toff;
6105 bfd_vma trampoff;
6106 };
6107
6108 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6109 bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
6110 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf = NULL;
6111 Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs = NULL;
6112 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *irelend = NULL;
6113 struct one_branch_fixup *branch_fixups = NULL;
6114 struct ppc_elf_relax_info *relax_info = NULL;
6115 unsigned changes = 0;
6116 bfd_boolean workaround_change;
6117 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
6118 bfd_size_type trampbase, trampoff, newsize, picfixup_size;
6119 asection *got2;
6120 bfd_boolean maybe_pasted;
6121
6122 *again = FALSE;
6123
6124 /* No need to do anything with non-alloc or non-code sections. */
6125 if ((isec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
6126 || (isec->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0
6127 || (isec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0
6128 || isec->size < 4)
6129 return TRUE;
6130
6131 /* We cannot represent the required PIC relocs in the output, so don't
6132 do anything. The linker doesn't support mixing -shared and -r
6133 anyway. */
6134 if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) && bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6135 return TRUE;
6136
6137 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (link_info);
6138 if (htab == NULL)
6139 return TRUE;
6140
6141 isec->size = (isec->size + 3) & -4;
6142 if (isec->rawsize == 0)
6143 isec->rawsize = isec->size;
6144 trampbase = isec->size;
6145
6146 BFD_ASSERT (isec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_NONE
6147 || isec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET);
6148 isec->sec_info_type = SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET;
6149
6150 if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
6151 || htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6152 {
6153 if (elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info == NULL)
6154 {
6155 elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info
6156 = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc_elf_relax_info));
6157 if (elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info == NULL)
6158 return FALSE;
6159 }
6160 relax_info = elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info;
6161 trampbase -= relax_info->workaround_size;
6162 }
6163
6164 maybe_pasted = (strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
6165 || strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0);
6166 /* Space for a branch around any trampolines. */
6167 trampoff = trampbase;
6168 if (maybe_pasted && trampbase == isec->rawsize)
6169 trampoff += 4;
6170
6171 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
6172 picfixup_size = 0;
6173 if (htab->params->branch_trampolines
6174 || htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6175 {
6176 /* Get a copy of the native relocations. */
6177 if (isec->reloc_count != 0)
6178 {
6179 internal_relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, isec, NULL, NULL,
6180 link_info->keep_memory);
6181 if (internal_relocs == NULL)
6182 goto error_return;
6183 }
6184
6185 got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got2");
6186
6187 irelend = internal_relocs + isec->reloc_count;
6188 for (irel = internal_relocs; irel < irelend; irel++)
6189 {
6190 unsigned long r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info);
6191 bfd_vma toff, roff;
6192 asection *tsec;
6193 struct one_branch_fixup *f;
6194 size_t insn_offset = 0;
6195 bfd_vma max_branch_offset = 0, val;
6196 bfd_byte *hit_addr;
6197 unsigned long t0;
6198 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6199 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
6200 struct plt_entry **plist;
6201 unsigned char sym_type;
6202
6203 switch (r_type)
6204 {
6205 case R_PPC_REL24:
6206 case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
6207 case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
6208 case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
6209 max_branch_offset = 1 << 25;
6210 break;
6211
6212 case R_PPC_REL14:
6213 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
6214 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
6215 max_branch_offset = 1 << 15;
6216 break;
6217
6218 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
6219 if (htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6220 break;
6221 continue;
6222
6223 default:
6224 continue;
6225 }
6226
6227 /* Get the value of the symbol referred to by the reloc. */
6228 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &isym, &tsec, NULL, &isymbuf,
6229 ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info), abfd))
6230 goto error_return;
6231
6232 if (isym != NULL)
6233 {
6234 if (tsec != NULL)
6235 ;
6236 else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
6237 tsec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
6238 else
6239 continue;
6240
6241 toff = isym->st_value;
6242 sym_type = ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info);
6243 }
6244 else
6245 {
6246 if (tsec != NULL)
6247 toff = h->root.u.def.value;
6248 else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
6249 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6250 {
6251 unsigned long indx;
6252
6253 indx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info) - symtab_hdr->sh_info;
6254 tsec = bfd_und_section_ptr;
6255 toff = bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) ? indx : 0;
6256 }
6257 else
6258 continue;
6259
6260 /* If this branch is to __tls_get_addr then we may later
6261 optimise away the call. We won't be needing a long-
6262 branch stub in that case. */
6263 if (bfd_link_executable (link_info)
6264 && h == htab->tls_get_addr
6265 && irel != internal_relocs)
6266 {
6267 unsigned long t_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel[-1].r_info);
6268 unsigned long t_rtype = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel[-1].r_info);
6269 unsigned int tls_mask = 0;
6270
6271 /* The previous reloc should be one of R_PPC_TLSGD or
6272 R_PPC_TLSLD, or for older object files, a reloc
6273 on the __tls_get_addr arg setup insn. Get tls
6274 mask bits from the symbol on that reloc. */
6275 if (t_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
6276 {
6277 bfd_vma *local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (abfd);
6278
6279 if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
6280 {
6281 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
6282 (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6283 char *lgot_masks = (char *)
6284 (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6285 tls_mask = lgot_masks[t_symndx];
6286 }
6287 }
6288 else
6289 {
6290 struct elf_link_hash_entry *th
6291 = elf_sym_hashes (abfd)[t_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
6292
6293 while (th->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
6294 || th->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
6295 th = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) th->root.u.i.link;
6296
6297 tls_mask
6298 = ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) th)->tls_mask;
6299 }
6300
6301 /* The mask bits tell us if the call will be
6302 optimised away. */
6303 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
6304 && (t_rtype == R_PPC_TLSGD
6305 || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16
6306 || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO))
6307 continue;
6308 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
6309 && (t_rtype == R_PPC_TLSLD
6310 || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16
6311 || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO))
6312 continue;
6313 }
6314
6315 sym_type = h->type;
6316 }
6317
6318 if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
6319 {
6320 if (h != NULL
6321 && !h->def_regular
6322 && h->protected_def
6323 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
6324 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo)
6325 picfixup_size += 12;
6326 continue;
6327 }
6328
6329 /* The condition here under which we call find_plt_ent must
6330 match that in relocate_section. If we call find_plt_ent here
6331 but not in relocate_section, or vice versa, then the branch
6332 destination used here may be incorrect. */
6333 plist = NULL;
6334 if (h != NULL)
6335 {
6336 /* We know is_branch_reloc (r_type) is true. */
6337 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
6338 || r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6339 plist = &h->plt.plist;
6340 }
6341 else if (sym_type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
6342 && elf_local_got_offsets (abfd) != NULL)
6343 {
6344 bfd_vma *local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (abfd);
6345 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
6346 (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6347 plist = local_plt + ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info);
6348 }
6349 if (plist != NULL)
6350 {
6351 bfd_vma addend = 0;
6352 struct plt_entry *ent;
6353
6354 if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24 && bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6355 addend = irel->r_addend;
6356 ent = find_plt_ent (plist, got2, addend);
6357 if (ent != NULL)
6358 {
6359 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
6360 || h == NULL
6361 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
6362 || h->dynindx == -1)
6363 {
6364 tsec = htab->glink;
6365 toff = ent->glink_offset;
6366 }
6367 else
6368 {
6369 tsec = htab->elf.splt;
6370 toff = ent->plt.offset;
6371 }
6372 }
6373 }
6374
6375 /* If the branch and target are in the same section, you have
6376 no hope of adding stubs. We'll error out later should the
6377 branch overflow. */
6378 if (tsec == isec)
6379 continue;
6380
6381 /* toff is used for the symbol index when the symbol is
6382 undefined and we're doing a relocatable link, so we can't
6383 support addends. It would be possible to do so by
6384 putting the addend in one_branch_fixup but addends on
6385 branches are rare so it hardly seems worth supporting. */
6386 if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6387 && tsec == bfd_und_section_ptr
6388 && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24
6389 && irel->r_addend != 0)
6390 continue;
6391
6392 /* There probably isn't any reason to handle symbols in
6393 SEC_MERGE sections; SEC_MERGE doesn't seem a likely
6394 attribute for a code section, and we are only looking at
6395 branches. However, implement it correctly here as a
6396 reference for other target relax_section functions. */
6397 if (0 && tsec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
6398 {
6399 /* At this stage in linking, no SEC_MERGE symbol has been
6400 adjusted, so all references to such symbols need to be
6401 passed through _bfd_merged_section_offset. (Later, in
6402 relocate_section, all SEC_MERGE symbols *except* for
6403 section symbols have been adjusted.)
6404
6405 gas may reduce relocations against symbols in SEC_MERGE
6406 sections to a relocation against the section symbol when
6407 the original addend was zero. When the reloc is against
6408 a section symbol we should include the addend in the
6409 offset passed to _bfd_merged_section_offset, since the
6410 location of interest is the original symbol. On the
6411 other hand, an access to "sym+addend" where "sym" is not
6412 a section symbol should not include the addend; Such an
6413 access is presumed to be an offset from "sym"; The
6414 location of interest is just "sym". */
6415 if (sym_type == STT_SECTION
6416 && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6417 toff += irel->r_addend;
6418
6419 toff
6420 = _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, &tsec,
6421 elf_section_data (tsec)->sec_info,
6422 toff);
6423
6424 if (sym_type != STT_SECTION
6425 && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6426 toff += irel->r_addend;
6427 }
6428 /* PLTREL24 addends are special. */
6429 else if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6430 toff += irel->r_addend;
6431
6432 /* Attempted -shared link of non-pic code loses. */
6433 if ((!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6434 && tsec == bfd_und_section_ptr)
6435 || tsec->output_section == NULL
6436 || (tsec->owner != NULL
6437 && (tsec->owner->flags & BFD_PLUGIN) != 0))
6438 continue;
6439
6440 roff = irel->r_offset;
6441
6442 /* Avoid creating a lot of unnecessary fixups when
6443 relocatable if the output section size is such that a
6444 fixup can be created at final link.
6445 The max_branch_offset adjustment allows for some number
6446 of other fixups being needed at final link. */
6447 if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6448 && (isec->output_section->rawsize - (isec->output_offset + roff)
6449 < max_branch_offset - (max_branch_offset >> 4)))
6450 continue;
6451
6452 /* If the branch is in range, no need to do anything. */
6453 if (tsec != bfd_und_section_ptr
6454 && (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6455 /* A relocatable link may have sections moved during
6456 final link, so do not presume they remain in range. */
6457 || tsec->output_section == isec->output_section))
6458 {
6459 bfd_vma symaddr, reladdr;
6460
6461 symaddr = tsec->output_section->vma + tsec->output_offset + toff;
6462 reladdr = isec->output_section->vma + isec->output_offset + roff;
6463 if (symaddr - reladdr + max_branch_offset
6464 < 2 * max_branch_offset)
6465 continue;
6466 }
6467
6468 /* Look for an existing fixup to this address. */
6469 for (f = branch_fixups; f ; f = f->next)
6470 if (f->tsec == tsec && f->toff == toff)
6471 break;
6472
6473 if (f == NULL)
6474 {
6475 size_t size;
6476 unsigned long stub_rtype;
6477
6478 val = trampoff - roff;
6479 if (val >= max_branch_offset)
6480 /* Oh dear, we can't reach a trampoline. Don't try to add
6481 one. We'll report an error later. */
6482 continue;
6483
6484 if (bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6485 {
6486 size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry);
6487 insn_offset = 12;
6488 }
6489 else
6490 {
6491 size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry);
6492 insn_offset = 0;
6493 }
6494 stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX;
6495 if (tsec == htab->elf.splt
6496 || tsec == htab->glink)
6497 {
6498 stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX_PLT;
6499 if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6500 stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24;
6501 }
6502
6503 /* Hijack the old relocation. Since we need two
6504 relocations for this use a "composite" reloc. */
6505 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info),
6506 stub_rtype);
6507 irel->r_offset = trampoff + insn_offset;
6508 if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
6509 && stub_rtype != R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24)
6510 irel->r_addend = 0;
6511
6512 /* Record the fixup so we don't do it again this section. */
6513 f = bfd_malloc (sizeof (*f));
6514 f->next = branch_fixups;
6515 f->tsec = tsec;
6516 f->toff = toff;
6517 f->trampoff = trampoff;
6518 branch_fixups = f;
6519
6520 trampoff += size;
6521 changes++;
6522 }
6523 else
6524 {
6525 val = f->trampoff - roff;
6526 if (val >= max_branch_offset)
6527 continue;
6528
6529 /* Nop out the reloc, since we're finalizing things here. */
6530 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_NONE);
6531 }
6532
6533 /* Get the section contents. */
6534 if (contents == NULL)
6535 {
6536 /* Get cached copy if it exists. */
6537 if (elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != NULL)
6538 contents = elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents;
6539 /* Go get them off disk. */
6540 else if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, isec, &contents))
6541 goto error_return;
6542 }
6543
6544 /* Fix up the existing branch to hit the trampoline. */
6545 hit_addr = contents + roff;
6546 switch (r_type)
6547 {
6548 case R_PPC_REL24:
6549 case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
6550 case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
6551 t0 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, hit_addr);
6552 t0 &= ~0x3fffffc;
6553 t0 |= val & 0x3fffffc;
6554 bfd_put_32 (abfd, t0, hit_addr);
6555 break;
6556
6557 case R_PPC_REL14:
6558 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
6559 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
6560 t0 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, hit_addr);
6561 t0 &= ~0xfffc;
6562 t0 |= val & 0xfffc;
6563 bfd_put_32 (abfd, t0, hit_addr);
6564 break;
6565 }
6566 }
6567
6568 while (branch_fixups != NULL)
6569 {
6570 struct one_branch_fixup *f = branch_fixups;
6571 branch_fixups = branch_fixups->next;
6572 free (f);
6573 }
6574 }
6575
6576 workaround_change = FALSE;
6577 newsize = trampoff;
6578 if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
6579 && (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6580 || isec->output_section->alignment_power >= htab->params->pagesize_p2))
6581 {
6582 bfd_vma addr, end_addr;
6583 unsigned int crossings;
6584 bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
6585
6586 addr = isec->output_section->vma + isec->output_offset;
6587 end_addr = addr + trampoff;
6588 addr &= -pagesize;
6589 crossings = ((end_addr & -pagesize) - addr) >> htab->params->pagesize_p2;
6590 if (crossings != 0)
6591 {
6592 /* Keep space aligned, to ensure the patch code itself does
6593 not cross a page. Don't decrease size calculated on a
6594 previous pass as otherwise we might never settle on a layout. */
6595 newsize = 15 - ((end_addr - 1) & 15);
6596 newsize += crossings * 16;
6597 if (relax_info->workaround_size < newsize)
6598 {
6599 relax_info->workaround_size = newsize;
6600 workaround_change = TRUE;
6601 }
6602 /* Ensure relocate_section is called. */
6603 isec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
6604 }
6605 newsize = trampoff + relax_info->workaround_size;
6606 }
6607
6608 if (htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6609 {
6610 picfixup_size -= relax_info->picfixup_size;
6611 if (picfixup_size != 0)
6612 relax_info->picfixup_size += picfixup_size;
6613 newsize += relax_info->picfixup_size;
6614 }
6615
6616 if (changes != 0 || picfixup_size != 0 || workaround_change)
6617 isec->size = newsize;
6618
6619 if (isymbuf != NULL
6620 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) isymbuf)
6621 {
6622 if (! link_info->keep_memory)
6623 free (isymbuf);
6624 else
6625 {
6626 /* Cache the symbols for elf_link_input_bfd. */
6627 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) isymbuf;
6628 }
6629 }
6630
6631 if (contents != NULL
6632 && elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6633 {
6634 if (!changes && !link_info->keep_memory)
6635 free (contents);
6636 else
6637 {
6638 /* Cache the section contents for elf_link_input_bfd. */
6639 elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
6640 }
6641 }
6642
6643 changes += picfixup_size;
6644 if (changes != 0)
6645 {
6646 /* Append sufficient NOP relocs so we can write out relocation
6647 information for the trampolines. */
6648 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
6649 Elf_Internal_Rela *new_relocs = bfd_malloc ((changes + isec->reloc_count)
6650 * sizeof (*new_relocs));
6651 unsigned ix;
6652
6653 if (!new_relocs)
6654 goto error_return;
6655 memcpy (new_relocs, internal_relocs,
6656 isec->reloc_count * sizeof (*new_relocs));
6657 for (ix = changes; ix--;)
6658 {
6659 irel = new_relocs + ix + isec->reloc_count;
6660
6661 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_NONE);
6662 }
6663 if (internal_relocs != elf_section_data (isec)->relocs)
6664 free (internal_relocs);
6665 elf_section_data (isec)->relocs = new_relocs;
6666 isec->reloc_count += changes;
6667 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (isec);
6668 rel_hdr->sh_size += changes * rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
6669 }
6670 else if (internal_relocs != NULL
6671 && elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
6672 free (internal_relocs);
6673
6674 *again = changes != 0 || workaround_change;
6675 return TRUE;
6676
6677 error_return:
6678 while (branch_fixups != NULL)
6679 {
6680 struct one_branch_fixup *f = branch_fixups;
6681 branch_fixups = branch_fixups->next;
6682 free (f);
6683 }
6684 if (isymbuf != NULL && (unsigned char *) isymbuf != symtab_hdr->contents)
6685 free (isymbuf);
6686 if (contents != NULL
6687 && elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6688 free (contents);
6689 if (internal_relocs != NULL
6690 && elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
6691 free (internal_relocs);
6692 return FALSE;
6693 }
6694 \f
6695 /* What to do when ld finds relocations against symbols defined in
6696 discarded sections. */
6697
6698 static unsigned int
6699 ppc_elf_action_discarded (asection *sec)
6700 {
6701 if (strcmp (".fixup", sec->name) == 0)
6702 return 0;
6703
6704 if (strcmp (".got2", sec->name) == 0)
6705 return 0;
6706
6707 return _bfd_elf_default_action_discarded (sec);
6708 }
6709 \f
6710 /* Fill in the address for a pointer generated in a linker section. */
6711
6712 static bfd_vma
6713 elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (bfd *input_bfd,
6714 elf_linker_section_t *lsect,
6715 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
6716 bfd_vma relocation,
6717 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
6718 {
6719 elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_ptr;
6720
6721 BFD_ASSERT (lsect != NULL);
6722
6723 if (h != NULL)
6724 {
6725 /* Handle global symbol. */
6726 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
6727
6728 eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6729 BFD_ASSERT (eh->elf.def_regular);
6730 linker_section_ptr = eh->linker_section_pointer;
6731 }
6732 else
6733 {
6734 /* Handle local symbol. */
6735 unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
6736
6737 BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (input_bfd));
6738 BFD_ASSERT (elf_local_ptr_offsets (input_bfd) != NULL);
6739 linker_section_ptr = elf_local_ptr_offsets (input_bfd)[r_symndx];
6740 }
6741
6742 linker_section_ptr = elf_find_pointer_linker_section (linker_section_ptr,
6743 rel->r_addend,
6744 lsect);
6745 BFD_ASSERT (linker_section_ptr != NULL);
6746
6747 /* Offset will always be a multiple of four, so use the bottom bit
6748 as a "written" flag. */
6749 if ((linker_section_ptr->offset & 1) == 0)
6750 {
6751 bfd_put_32 (lsect->section->owner,
6752 relocation + linker_section_ptr->addend,
6753 lsect->section->contents + linker_section_ptr->offset);
6754 linker_section_ptr->offset += 1;
6755 }
6756
6757 relocation = (lsect->section->output_section->vma
6758 + lsect->section->output_offset
6759 + linker_section_ptr->offset - 1
6760 - SYM_VAL (lsect->sym));
6761
6762 #ifdef DEBUG
6763 fprintf (stderr,
6764 "Finish pointer in linker section %s, offset = %ld (0x%lx)\n",
6765 lsect->name, (long) relocation, (long) relocation);
6766 #endif
6767
6768 return relocation;
6769 }
6770
6771 #define PPC_LO(v) ((v) & 0xffff)
6772 #define PPC_HI(v) (((v) >> 16) & 0xffff)
6773 #define PPC_HA(v) PPC_HI ((v) + 0x8000)
6774
6775 static void
6776 write_glink_stub (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, struct plt_entry *ent,
6777 asection *plt_sec, unsigned char *p,
6778 struct bfd_link_info *info)
6779 {
6780 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
6781 bfd *output_bfd = info->output_bfd;
6782 bfd_vma plt;
6783 unsigned char *end = p + GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, h);
6784
6785 if (h != NULL
6786 && h == htab->tls_get_addr
6787 && !htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt)
6788 {
6789 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_3, p);
6790 p += 4;
6791 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_3 + 4, p);
6792 p += 4;
6793 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MR_0_3, p);
6794 p += 4;
6795 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, CMPWI_11_0, p);
6796 p += 4;
6797 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_3_12_2, p);
6798 p += 4;
6799 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BEQLR, p);
6800 p += 4;
6801 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MR_3_0, p);
6802 p += 4;
6803 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, p);
6804 p += 4;
6805 }
6806
6807 plt = ((ent->plt.offset & ~1)
6808 + plt_sec->output_section->vma
6809 + plt_sec->output_offset);
6810
6811 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
6812 {
6813 bfd_vma got = 0;
6814
6815 if (ent->addend >= 32768)
6816 got = (ent->addend
6817 + ent->sec->output_section->vma
6818 + ent->sec->output_offset);
6819 else if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
6820 got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
6821
6822 plt -= got;
6823
6824 if (plt + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
6825 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_30 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6826 else
6827 {
6828 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_30 + PPC_HA (plt), p);
6829 p += 4;
6830 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_11 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6831 }
6832 }
6833 else
6834 {
6835 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LIS_11 + PPC_HA (plt), p);
6836 p += 4;
6837 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_11 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6838 }
6839 p += 4;
6840 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_11, p);
6841 p += 4;
6842 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCTR, p);
6843 p += 4;
6844 while (p < end)
6845 {
6846 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? BA : NOP, p);
6847 p += 4;
6848 }
6849 }
6850
6851 /* Return true if symbol is defined statically. */
6852
6853 static bfd_boolean
6854 is_static_defined (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6855 {
6856 return ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
6857 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
6858 && h->root.u.def.section != NULL
6859 && h->root.u.def.section->output_section != NULL);
6860 }
6861
6862 /* If INSN is an opcode that may be used with an @tls operand, return
6863 the transformed insn for TLS optimisation, otherwise return 0. If
6864 REG is non-zero only match an insn with RB or RA equal to REG. */
6865
6866 unsigned int
6867 _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (unsigned int insn, unsigned int reg)
6868 {
6869 unsigned int rtra;
6870
6871 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) != 31 << 26)
6872 return 0;
6873
6874 if (reg == 0 || ((insn >> 11) & 0x1f) == reg)
6875 rtra = insn & ((1 << 26) - (1 << 16));
6876 else if (((insn >> 16) & 0x1f) == reg)
6877 rtra = (insn & (0x1f << 21)) | ((insn & (0x1f << 11)) << 5);
6878 else
6879 return 0;
6880
6881 if ((insn & (0x3ff << 1)) == 266 << 1)
6882 /* add -> addi. */
6883 insn = 14 << 26;
6884 else if ((insn & (0x1f << 1)) == 23 << 1
6885 && ((insn & (0x1f << 6)) < 14 << 6
6886 || ((insn & (0x1f << 6)) >= 16 << 6
6887 && (insn & (0x1f << 6)) < 24 << 6)))
6888 /* load and store indexed -> dform. */
6889 insn = (32 | ((insn >> 6) & 0x1f)) << 26;
6890 else if ((insn & (((0x1a << 5) | 0x1f) << 1)) == 21 << 1)
6891 /* ldx, ldux, stdx, stdux -> ld, ldu, std, stdu. */
6892 insn = ((58 | ((insn >> 6) & 4)) << 26) | ((insn >> 6) & 1);
6893 else if ((insn & (((0x1f << 5) | 0x1f) << 1)) == 341 << 1)
6894 /* lwax -> lwa. */
6895 insn = (58 << 26) | 2;
6896 else
6897 return 0;
6898 insn |= rtra;
6899 return insn;
6900 }
6901
6902 /* If INSN is an opcode that may be used with an @tprel operand, return
6903 the transformed insn for an undefined weak symbol, ie. with the
6904 thread pointer REG operand removed. Otherwise return 0. */
6905
6906 unsigned int
6907 _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (unsigned int insn, unsigned int reg)
6908 {
6909 if ((insn & (0x1f << 16)) == reg << 16
6910 && ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 14u << 26 /* addi */
6911 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 15u << 26 /* addis */
6912 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
6913 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
6914 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
6915 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
6916 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
6917 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
6918 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
6919 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
6920 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
6921 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
6922 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
6923 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
6924 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
6925 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* lwa,ld,lmd */
6926 && (insn & 3) != 1)
6927 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std, stmd */
6928 && ((insn & 3) == 0 || (insn & 3) == 3))))
6929 {
6930 insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
6931 }
6932 else if ((insn & (0x1f << 21)) == reg << 21
6933 && ((insn & (0x3e << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori, oris */
6934 || (insn & (0x3e << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori,xoris */
6935 || (insn & (0x3e << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi,andis */))
6936 {
6937 insn &= ~(0x1f << 21);
6938 insn |= (insn & (0x1f << 16)) << 5;
6939 if ((insn & (0x3e << 26)) == 26 << 26 /* xori,xoris */)
6940 insn -= 2 >> 26; /* convert to ori,oris */
6941 }
6942 else
6943 insn = 0;
6944 return insn;
6945 }
6946
6947 static bfd_boolean
6948 is_insn_ds_form (unsigned int insn)
6949 {
6950 return ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* ld,ldu,lwa */
6951 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std,stdu,stq */
6952 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 57u << 26 /* lfdp */
6953 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 61u << 26 /* stfdp */);
6954 }
6955
6956 static bfd_boolean
6957 is_insn_dq_form (unsigned int insn)
6958 {
6959 return ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 56u << 26 /* lq */
6960 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (61u << 26) /* lxv, stxv */
6961 && (insn & 3) == 1));
6962 }
6963
6964 /* The RELOCATE_SECTION function is called by the ELF backend linker
6965 to handle the relocations for a section.
6966
6967 The relocs are always passed as Rela structures; if the section
6968 actually uses Rel structures, the r_addend field will always be
6969 zero.
6970
6971 This function is responsible for adjust the section contents as
6972 necessary, and (if using Rela relocs and generating a
6973 relocatable output file) adjusting the reloc addend as
6974 necessary.
6975
6976 This function does not have to worry about setting the reloc
6977 address or the reloc symbol index.
6978
6979 LOCAL_SYMS is a pointer to the swapped in local symbols.
6980
6981 LOCAL_SECTIONS is an array giving the section in the input file
6982 corresponding to the st_shndx field of each local symbol.
6983
6984 The global hash table entry for the global symbols can be found
6985 via elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd).
6986
6987 When generating relocatable output, this function must handle
6988 STB_LOCAL/STT_SECTION symbols specially. The output symbol is
6989 going to be the section symbol corresponding to the output
6990 section, which means that the addend must be adjusted
6991 accordingly. */
6992
6993 static bfd_boolean
6994 ppc_elf_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd,
6995 struct bfd_link_info *info,
6996 bfd *input_bfd,
6997 asection *input_section,
6998 bfd_byte *contents,
6999 Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
7000 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
7001 asection **local_sections)
7002 {
7003 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
7004 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
7005 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
7006 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
7007 Elf_Internal_Rela *wrel;
7008 Elf_Internal_Rela *relend;
7009 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
7010 asection *got2;
7011 bfd_vma *local_got_offsets;
7012 bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
7013 bfd_vma d_offset = (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd) ? 2 : 0);
7014 bfd_boolean is_vxworks_tls;
7015 unsigned int picfixup_size = 0;
7016 struct ppc_elf_relax_info *relax_info = NULL;
7017
7018 #ifdef DEBUG
7019 _bfd_error_handler ("ppc_elf_relocate_section called for %pB section %pA, "
7020 "%ld relocations%s",
7021 input_bfd, input_section,
7022 (long) input_section->reloc_count,
7023 (bfd_link_relocatable (info)) ? " (relocatable)" : "");
7024 #endif
7025
7026 if (!is_ppc_elf (input_bfd))
7027 {
7028 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
7029 return FALSE;
7030 }
7031
7032 got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (input_bfd, ".got2");
7033
7034 /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
7035 if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
7036 ppc_elf_howto_init ();
7037
7038 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
7039 local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (input_bfd);
7040 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (input_bfd);
7041 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd);
7042 /* We have to handle relocations in vxworks .tls_vars sections
7043 specially, because the dynamic loader is 'weird'. */
7044 is_vxworks_tls = (htab->is_vxworks && bfd_link_pic (info)
7045 && !strcmp (input_section->output_section->name,
7046 ".tls_vars"));
7047 if (input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET)
7048 relax_info = elf_section_data (input_section)->sec_info;
7049 rel = wrel = relocs;
7050 relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count;
7051 for (; rel < relend; wrel++, rel++)
7052 {
7053 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
7054 bfd_vma addend;
7055 bfd_reloc_status_type r;
7056 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
7057 asection *sec;
7058 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7059 const char *sym_name;
7060 reloc_howto_type *howto;
7061 unsigned long r_symndx;
7062 bfd_vma relocation;
7063 bfd_vma branch_bit, from;
7064 bfd_boolean unresolved_reloc, save_unresolved_reloc;
7065 bfd_boolean warned;
7066 unsigned int tls_type, tls_mask, tls_gd;
7067 struct plt_entry **ifunc, **plt_list;
7068 struct reloc_howto_struct alt_howto;
7069
7070 again:
7071 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
7072 sym = NULL;
7073 sec = NULL;
7074 h = NULL;
7075 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7076 warned = FALSE;
7077 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
7078
7079 if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7080 {
7081 sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
7082 sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
7083 sym_name = bfd_elf_sym_name (input_bfd, symtab_hdr, sym, sec);
7084
7085 relocation = _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (output_bfd, sym, &sec, rel);
7086 }
7087 else
7088 {
7089 bfd_boolean ignored;
7090
7091 RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL (info, input_bfd, input_section, rel,
7092 r_symndx, symtab_hdr, sym_hashes,
7093 h, sec, relocation,
7094 unresolved_reloc, warned, ignored);
7095
7096 sym_name = h->root.root.string;
7097 }
7098
7099 if (sec != NULL && discarded_section (sec))
7100 {
7101 /* For relocs against symbols from removed linkonce sections,
7102 or sections discarded by a linker script, we just want the
7103 section contents zeroed. Avoid any special processing. */
7104 howto = NULL;
7105 if (r_type < R_PPC_max)
7106 howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
7107
7108 _bfd_clear_contents (howto, input_bfd, input_section,
7109 contents, rel->r_offset);
7110 wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset;
7111 wrel->r_info = 0;
7112 wrel->r_addend = 0;
7113
7114 /* For ld -r, remove relocations in debug sections against
7115 symbols defined in discarded sections. Not done for
7116 non-debug to preserve relocs in .eh_frame which the
7117 eh_frame editing code expects to be present. */
7118 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info)
7119 && (input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING))
7120 wrel--;
7121
7122 continue;
7123 }
7124
7125 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
7126 {
7127 if (got2 != NULL
7128 && r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
7129 && rel->r_addend != 0)
7130 {
7131 /* R_PPC_PLTREL24 is rather special. If non-zero, the
7132 addend specifies the GOT pointer offset within .got2. */
7133 rel->r_addend += got2->output_offset;
7134 }
7135 if (r_type != R_PPC_RELAX_PLT
7136 && r_type != R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24
7137 && r_type != R_PPC_RELAX)
7138 goto copy_reloc;
7139 }
7140
7141 /* TLS optimizations. Replace instruction sequences and relocs
7142 based on information we collected in tls_optimize. We edit
7143 RELOCS so that --emit-relocs will output something sensible
7144 for the final instruction stream. */
7145 tls_mask = 0;
7146 tls_gd = 0;
7147 if (h != NULL)
7148 tls_mask = ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->tls_mask;
7149 else if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
7150 {
7151 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
7152 char *lgot_masks;
7153 local_plt
7154 = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7155 lgot_masks = (char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7156 tls_mask = lgot_masks[r_symndx];
7157 }
7158
7159 /* Ensure reloc mapping code below stays sane. */
7160 if ((R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)
7161 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO & 3)
7162 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI & 3)
7163 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA & 3)
7164 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16 & 3)
7165 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO & 3)
7166 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI & 3)
7167 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA & 3))
7168 abort ();
7169 switch (r_type)
7170 {
7171 default:
7172 break;
7173
7174 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
7175 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
7176 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7177 && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
7178 {
7179 bfd_vma insn;
7180
7181 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7182 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7183 insn &= 31 << 21;
7184 insn |= 0x3c020000; /* addis 0,2,0 */
7185 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
7186 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7187 r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;
7188 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7189 }
7190 break;
7191
7192 case R_PPC_TLS:
7193 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7194 && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
7195 {
7196 bfd_vma insn;
7197
7198 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
7199 insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (insn, 2);
7200 if (insn == 0)
7201 abort ();
7202 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
7203 r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;
7204 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7205
7206 /* Was PPC_TLS which sits on insn boundary, now
7207 PPC_TPREL16_LO which is at low-order half-word. */
7208 rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7209 }
7210 break;
7211
7212 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
7213 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
7214 tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
7215 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
7216 goto tls_gdld_hi;
7217 break;
7218
7219 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
7220 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
7221 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
7222 {
7223 tls_gdld_hi:
7224 if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
7225 r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
7226 + R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16);
7227 else
7228 {
7229 rel->r_offset -= d_offset;
7230 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
7231 r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
7232 }
7233 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7234 }
7235 break;
7236
7237 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
7238 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
7239 tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
7240 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
7241 goto tls_ldgd_opt;
7242 break;
7243
7244 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
7245 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
7246 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
7247 {
7248 unsigned int insn1, insn2;
7249 bfd_vma offset;
7250
7251 tls_ldgd_opt:
7252 offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
7253 /* If not using the newer R_PPC_TLSGD/LD to mark
7254 __tls_get_addr calls, we must trust that the call
7255 stays with its arg setup insns, ie. that the next
7256 reloc is the __tls_get_addr call associated with
7257 the current reloc. Edit both insns. */
7258 if (input_section->has_tls_get_addr_call
7259 && rel + 1 < relend
7260 && branch_reloc_hash_match (input_bfd, rel + 1,
7261 htab->tls_get_addr))
7262 offset = rel[1].r_offset;
7263 /* We read the low GOT_TLS insn because we need to keep
7264 the destination reg. It may be something other than
7265 the usual r3, and moved to r3 before the call by
7266 intervening code. */
7267 insn1 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7268 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7269 if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
7270 {
7271 /* IE */
7272 insn1 &= (0x1f << 21) | (0x1f << 16);
7273 insn1 |= 32 << 26; /* lwz */
7274 if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
7275 {
7276 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7277 insn2 = 0x7c631214; /* add 3,3,2 */
7278 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7279 }
7280 r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
7281 + R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16);
7282 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7283 }
7284 else
7285 {
7286 /* LE */
7287 insn1 &= 0x1f << 21;
7288 insn1 |= 0x3c020000; /* addis r,2,0 */
7289 if (tls_gd == 0)
7290 {
7291 /* Was an LD reloc. */
7292 for (r_symndx = 0;
7293 r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7294 r_symndx++)
7295 if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec)
7296 break;
7297 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7298 r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
7299 rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7300 if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF)
7301 rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value
7302 + sec->output_offset
7303 + sec->output_section->vma);
7304 }
7305 r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;
7306 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7307 if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
7308 {
7309 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_TPREL16_LO);
7310 rel[1].r_offset = offset + d_offset;
7311 rel[1].r_addend = rel->r_addend;
7312 insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
7313 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7314 }
7315 }
7316 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn1,
7317 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7318 if (tls_gd == 0)
7319 {
7320 /* We changed the symbol on an LD reloc. Start over
7321 in order to get h, sym, sec etc. right. */
7322 goto again;
7323 }
7324 }
7325 break;
7326
7327 case R_PPC_TLSGD:
7328 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
7329 && rel + 1 < relend)
7330 {
7331 unsigned int insn2;
7332 bfd_vma offset = rel->r_offset;
7333
7334 if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
7335 {
7336 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + offset);
7337 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7338 break;
7339 }
7340
7341 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GDIE) != 0)
7342 {
7343 /* IE */
7344 r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
7345 insn2 = 0x7c631214; /* add 3,3,2 */
7346 }
7347 else
7348 {
7349 /* LE */
7350 r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;
7351 rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7352 insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
7353 }
7354 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7355 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7356 /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too. */
7357 BFD_ASSERT (offset == rel[1].r_offset);
7358 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7359 }
7360 break;
7361
7362 case R_PPC_TLSLD:
7363 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
7364 && rel + 1 < relend)
7365 {
7366 unsigned int insn2;
7367
7368 if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
7369 {
7370 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
7371 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7372 break;
7373 }
7374
7375 for (r_symndx = 0;
7376 r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7377 r_symndx++)
7378 if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec)
7379 break;
7380 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7381 r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
7382 rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7383 if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF)
7384 rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value
7385 + sec->output_offset
7386 + sec->output_section->vma);
7387
7388 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_TPREL16_LO);
7389 rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7390 insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
7391 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2,
7392 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7393 /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too. */
7394 BFD_ASSERT (rel->r_offset - d_offset == rel[1].r_offset);
7395 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7396 goto again;
7397 }
7398 break;
7399 }
7400
7401 /* Handle other relocations that tweak non-addend part of insn. */
7402 branch_bit = 0;
7403 switch (r_type)
7404 {
7405 default:
7406 break;
7407
7408 /* Branch taken prediction relocations. */
7409 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
7410 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
7411 branch_bit = BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7412 /* Fall through. */
7413
7414 /* Branch not taken prediction relocations. */
7415 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
7416 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
7417 {
7418 unsigned int insn;
7419
7420 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
7421 insn &= ~BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7422 insn |= branch_bit;
7423
7424 from = (rel->r_offset
7425 + input_section->output_offset
7426 + input_section->output_section->vma);
7427
7428 /* Invert 'y' bit if not the default. */
7429 if ((bfd_signed_vma) (relocation + rel->r_addend - from) < 0)
7430 insn ^= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7431
7432 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
7433 }
7434 break;
7435
7436 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
7437 {
7438 unsigned int insn;
7439
7440 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7441 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7442 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 15u << 26
7443 && (insn & (0x1f << 16)) != 0)
7444 {
7445 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
7446 {
7447 /* Convert addis to lis. */
7448 insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
7449 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
7450 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7451 }
7452 }
7453 else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
7454 info->callbacks->einfo
7455 (_("%P: %H: error: %s with unexpected instruction %x\n"),
7456 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
7457 "R_PPC_PLT16_HA", insn);
7458 }
7459 break;
7460 }
7461
7462 if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
7463 && h != NULL
7464 && !h->def_regular
7465 && h->protected_def
7466 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
7467 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo
7468 && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
7469 {
7470 /* Convert lis;addi or lis;load/store accessing a protected
7471 variable defined in a shared library to PIC. */
7472 unsigned int insn;
7473
7474 if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
7475 {
7476 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7477 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7478 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (15u << 26)
7479 && (insn & (0x1f << 16)) == 0 /* lis */)
7480 {
7481 bfd_byte *p;
7482 bfd_vma off;
7483 bfd_vma got_addr;
7484
7485 p = (contents + input_section->size
7486 - relax_info->workaround_size
7487 - relax_info->picfixup_size
7488 + picfixup_size);
7489 off = (p - contents) - (rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7490 if (off > 0x1fffffc || (off & 3) != 0)
7491 info->callbacks->einfo
7492 (_("%H: fixup branch overflow\n"),
7493 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
7494
7495 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | off,
7496 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7497 got_addr = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7498 + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7499 + (h->got.offset & ~1));
7500 wrel->r_offset = (p - contents) + d_offset;
7501 wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
7502 wrel->r_addend = got_addr;
7503 insn &= ~0xffff;
7504 insn |= ((unsigned int) (got_addr + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
7505 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
7506
7507 /* Convert lis to lwz, loading address from GOT. */
7508 insn &= ~0xffff;
7509 insn ^= (32u ^ 15u) << 26;
7510 insn |= (insn & (0x1f << 21)) >> 5;
7511 insn |= got_addr & 0xffff;
7512 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p + 4);
7513
7514 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | ((-4 - off) & 0x3ffffff), p + 8);
7515 picfixup_size += 12;
7516
7517 /* Use one of the spare relocs, so --emit-relocs
7518 output is reasonable. */
7519 memmove (rel + 1, rel, (relend - rel - 1) * sizeof (*rel));
7520 wrel++, rel++;
7521 rel->r_offset = wrel[-1].r_offset + 4;
7522 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
7523 rel->r_addend = wrel[-1].r_addend;
7524
7525 /* Continue on as if we had a got reloc, to output
7526 dynamic reloc. */
7527 r_type = R_PPC_GOT16_LO;
7528 }
7529 else
7530 _bfd_error_handler
7531 /* xgettext:c-format */
7532 (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): error: "
7533 "%s with unexpected instruction %#x"),
7534 input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
7535 "R_PPC_ADDR16_HA", insn);
7536 }
7537 else if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_LO)
7538 {
7539 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7540 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7541 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 14u << 26 /* addi */
7542 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
7543 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
7544 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
7545 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
7546 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
7547 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
7548 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
7549 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
7550 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
7551 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
7552 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
7553 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
7554 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
7555 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* lwa,ld,lmd */
7556 && (insn & 3) != 1)
7557 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std, stmd */
7558 && ((insn & 3) == 0 || (insn & 3) == 3)))
7559 {
7560 /* Arrange to apply the reloc addend, if any. */
7561 relocation = 0;
7562 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7563 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, r_type);
7564 }
7565 else
7566 _bfd_error_handler
7567 /* xgettext:c-format */
7568 (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): error: "
7569 "%s with unexpected instruction %#x"),
7570 input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
7571 "R_PPC_ADDR16_LO", insn);
7572 }
7573 }
7574
7575 ifunc = NULL;
7576 if (!htab->is_vxworks)
7577 {
7578 struct plt_entry *ent;
7579
7580 if (h != NULL)
7581 {
7582 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
7583 ifunc = &h->plt.plist;
7584 }
7585 else if (local_got_offsets != NULL
7586 && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
7587 {
7588 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
7589
7590 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets
7591 + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7592 ifunc = local_plt + r_symndx;
7593 }
7594
7595 ent = NULL;
7596 if (ifunc != NULL
7597 && (!bfd_link_pic (info)
7598 || is_branch_reloc (r_type)
7599 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
7600 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
7601 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
7602 {
7603 addend = 0;
7604 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
7605 && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
7606 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
7607 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
7608 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
7609 addend = rel->r_addend;
7610 ent = find_plt_ent (ifunc, got2, addend);
7611 }
7612 if (ent != NULL)
7613 {
7614 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
7615 && ent->sec != got2
7616 && htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW
7617 && (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7618 || h == NULL
7619 || h->dynindx == -1))
7620 {
7621 /* Uh oh, we are going to create a pic glink stub
7622 for an ifunc (here for h == NULL and later in
7623 finish_dynamic_symbol for h != NULL), and
7624 apparently are using code compiled with
7625 -mbss-plt. The difficulty is that -mbss-plt code
7626 gives no indication via a magic PLTREL24 addend
7627 whether r30 is equal to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ or
7628 is pointing into a .got2 section (and how far
7629 into .got2). */
7630 info->callbacks->einfo
7631 /* xgettext:c-format */
7632 (_("%X%H: unsupported bss-plt -fPIC ifunc %s\n"),
7633 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, sym_name);
7634 }
7635
7636 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7637 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
7638 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7639 || h == NULL
7640 || h->dynindx == -1)
7641 relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
7642 + htab->glink->output_offset
7643 + (ent->glink_offset & ~1));
7644 else
7645 relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
7646 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
7647 + ent->plt.offset);
7648 }
7649 }
7650
7651 addend = rel->r_addend;
7652 save_unresolved_reloc = unresolved_reloc;
7653 howto = NULL;
7654 if (r_type < R_PPC_max)
7655 howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
7656
7657 switch (r_type)
7658 {
7659 default:
7660 break;
7661
7662 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
7663 if (htab->do_tls_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
7664 {
7665 bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
7666 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
7667 if ((insn & ((0x3f << 26) | 0x1f << 16))
7668 != ((15u << 26) | (2 << 16)) /* addis rt,2,imm */)
7669 /* xgettext:c-format */
7670 info->callbacks->minfo
7671 (_("%H: warning: %s unexpected insn %#x.\n"),
7672 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, howto->name, insn);
7673 else
7674 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
7675 }
7676 break;
7677
7678 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
7679 if (htab->do_tls_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
7680 {
7681 bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
7682 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
7683 insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
7684 insn |= 2 << 16;
7685 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
7686 }
7687 break;
7688 }
7689
7690 tls_type = 0;
7691 switch (r_type)
7692 {
7693 default:
7694 /* xgettext:c-format */
7695 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
7696 input_bfd, howto->name);
7697
7698 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
7699 ret = FALSE;
7700 goto copy_reloc;
7701
7702 case R_PPC_NONE:
7703 case R_PPC_TLS:
7704 case R_PPC_TLSGD:
7705 case R_PPC_TLSLD:
7706 case R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:
7707 case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
7708 case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
7709 goto copy_reloc;
7710
7711 /* GOT16 relocations. Like an ADDR16 using the symbol's
7712 address in the GOT as relocation value instead of the
7713 symbol's value itself. Also, create a GOT entry for the
7714 symbol and put the symbol value there. */
7715 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
7716 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
7717 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
7718 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
7719 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
7720 goto dogot;
7721
7722 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
7723 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
7724 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
7725 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
7726 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
7727 goto dogot;
7728
7729 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
7730 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
7731 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
7732 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
7733 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
7734 goto dogot;
7735
7736 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
7737 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
7738 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
7739 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
7740 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
7741 goto dogot;
7742
7743 case R_PPC_GOT16:
7744 case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
7745 case R_PPC_GOT16_HI:
7746 case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
7747 tls_mask = 0;
7748 dogot:
7749 {
7750 /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the global
7751 offset table. */
7752 bfd_vma off;
7753 bfd_vma *offp;
7754 unsigned long indx;
7755
7756 if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
7757 abort ();
7758
7759 indx = 0;
7760 if (tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)
7761 && (h == NULL
7762 || !h->def_dynamic))
7763 offp = &htab->tlsld_got.offset;
7764 else if (h != NULL)
7765 {
7766 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7767 || h->dynindx == -1
7768 || SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)
7769 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
7770 /* This is actually a static link, or it is a
7771 -Bsymbolic link and the symbol is defined
7772 locally, or the symbol was forced to be local
7773 because of a version file. */
7774 ;
7775 else
7776 {
7777 indx = h->dynindx;
7778 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7779 }
7780 offp = &h->got.offset;
7781 }
7782 else
7783 {
7784 if (local_got_offsets == NULL)
7785 abort ();
7786 offp = &local_got_offsets[r_symndx];
7787 }
7788
7789 /* The offset must always be a multiple of 4. We use the
7790 least significant bit to record whether we have already
7791 processed this entry. */
7792 off = *offp;
7793 if ((off & 1) != 0)
7794 off &= ~1;
7795 else
7796 {
7797 unsigned int tls_m = ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7798 ? tls_mask & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL
7799 | TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)
7800 : 0);
7801
7802 if (offp == &htab->tlsld_got.offset)
7803 tls_m = TLS_LD;
7804 else if (h == NULL
7805 || !h->def_dynamic)
7806 tls_m &= ~TLS_LD;
7807
7808 /* We might have multiple got entries for this sym.
7809 Initialize them all. */
7810 do
7811 {
7812 int tls_ty = 0;
7813
7814 if ((tls_m & TLS_LD) != 0)
7815 {
7816 tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
7817 tls_m &= ~TLS_LD;
7818 }
7819 else if ((tls_m & TLS_GD) != 0)
7820 {
7821 tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
7822 tls_m &= ~TLS_GD;
7823 }
7824 else if ((tls_m & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
7825 {
7826 tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
7827 tls_m &= ~TLS_DTPREL;
7828 }
7829 else if ((tls_m & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)) != 0)
7830 {
7831 tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
7832 tls_m = 0;
7833 }
7834
7835 /* Generate relocs for the dynamic linker. */
7836 if (indx != 0
7837 || (bfd_link_pic (info)
7838 && (h == NULL
7839 || !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)
7840 || offp == &htab->tlsld_got.offset)
7841 && !(tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL)
7842 && bfd_link_executable (info)
7843 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))))
7844 {
7845 asection *rsec = htab->elf.srelgot;
7846 bfd_byte * loc;
7847
7848 if (ifunc != NULL)
7849 {
7850 rsec = htab->elf.irelplt;
7851 if (indx == 0)
7852 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
7853 else if (is_static_defined (h))
7854 htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
7855 }
7856 outrel.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7857 + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7858 + off);
7859 outrel.r_addend = 0;
7860 if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7861 {
7862 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPMOD32);
7863 if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
7864 {
7865 loc = rsec->contents;
7866 loc += (rsec->reloc_count++
7867 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
7868 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd,
7869 &outrel, loc);
7870 outrel.r_offset += 4;
7871 outrel.r_info
7872 = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPREL32);
7873 }
7874 }
7875 else if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
7876 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPREL32);
7877 else if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL))
7878 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_TPREL32);
7879 else if (indx != 0)
7880 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_GLOB_DAT);
7881 else if (ifunc != NULL)
7882 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
7883 else
7884 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
7885 if (indx == 0 && tls_ty != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
7886 {
7887 outrel.r_addend += relocation;
7888 if (tls_ty & (TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL | TLS_TPREL))
7889 {
7890 if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
7891 outrel.r_addend = 0;
7892 else
7893 outrel.r_addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma;
7894 }
7895 }
7896 loc = rsec->contents;
7897 loc += (rsec->reloc_count++
7898 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
7899 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
7900 }
7901
7902 /* Init the .got section contents if we're not
7903 emitting a reloc. */
7904 else
7905 {
7906 bfd_vma value = relocation;
7907
7908 if (tls_ty != 0)
7909 {
7910 if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
7911 value = 0;
7912 else
7913 {
7914 if (tls_ty & TLS_LD)
7915 value = 0;
7916 else
7917 value -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7918 if (tls_ty & TLS_TPREL)
7919 value += DTP_OFFSET - TP_OFFSET;
7920 }
7921
7922 if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7923 {
7924 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value,
7925 htab->elf.sgot->contents + off + 4);
7926 value = 1;
7927 }
7928 }
7929 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value,
7930 htab->elf.sgot->contents + off);
7931 }
7932
7933 off += 4;
7934 if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7935 off += 4;
7936 }
7937 while (tls_m != 0);
7938
7939 off = *offp;
7940 *offp = off | 1;
7941 }
7942
7943 if (off >= (bfd_vma) -2)
7944 abort ();
7945
7946 if ((tls_type & TLS_TLS) != 0)
7947 {
7948 if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
7949 {
7950 if ((tls_mask & TLS_LD) != 0
7951 && !(h == NULL
7952 || !h->def_dynamic))
7953 off += 8;
7954 if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
7955 {
7956 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) != 0)
7957 off += 8;
7958 if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
7959 {
7960 if ((tls_mask & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
7961 off += 4;
7962 }
7963 }
7964 }
7965 }
7966
7967 /* If here for a picfixup, we're done. */
7968 if (r_type != ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
7969 goto copy_reloc;
7970
7971 relocation = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7972 + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7973 + off
7974 - SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot));
7975
7976 /* Addends on got relocations don't make much sense.
7977 x+off@got is actually x@got+off, and since the got is
7978 generated by a hash table traversal, the value in the
7979 got at entry m+n bears little relation to the entry m. */
7980 if (addend != 0)
7981 info->callbacks->einfo
7982 /* xgettext:c-format */
7983 (_("%H: non-zero addend on %s reloc against `%s'\n"),
7984 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
7985 howto->name,
7986 sym_name);
7987 }
7988 break;
7989
7990 /* Relocations that need no special processing. */
7991 case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
7992 /* It makes no sense to point a local relocation
7993 at a symbol not in this object. */
7994 if (unresolved_reloc)
7995 {
7996 (*info->callbacks->undefined_symbol) (info,
7997 h->root.root.string,
7998 input_bfd,
7999 input_section,
8000 rel->r_offset,
8001 TRUE);
8002 goto copy_reloc;
8003 }
8004 if (h != NULL && h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && bfd_link_pic (info))
8005 {
8006 /* @local on an ifunc does not really make sense since
8007 the ifunc resolver can take you anywhere. More
8008 seriously, calls to ifuncs must go through a plt call
8009 stub, and for pic the plt call stubs uses r30 to
8010 access the PLT. The problem is that a call that is
8011 local won't have the +32k reloc addend trick marking
8012 -fPIC code, so the linker won't know whether r30 is
8013 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ or pointing into a .got2 section. */
8014 /* xgettext:c-format */
8015 info->callbacks->einfo (_("%X%H: @local call to ifunc %s\n"),
8016 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8017 h->root.root.string);
8018 }
8019 break;
8020
8021 case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
8022 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
8023 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:
8024 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
8025 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8026 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
8027 break;
8028
8029 /* Relocations that may need to be propagated if this is a shared
8030 object. */
8031 case R_PPC_TPREL16:
8032 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
8033 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
8034 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
8035 if (h != NULL
8036 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
8037 && h->dynindx == -1)
8038 {
8039 /* Make this relocation against an undefined weak symbol
8040 resolve to zero. This is really just a tweak, since
8041 code using weak externs ought to check that they are
8042 defined before using them. */
8043 bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset;
8044 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
8045 insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (insn, 2);
8046 if (insn != 0)
8047 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
8048 break;
8049 }
8050 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8051 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
8052 /* The TPREL16 relocs shouldn't really be used in shared
8053 libs or with non-local symbols as that will result in
8054 DT_TEXTREL being set, but support them anyway. */
8055 goto dodyn;
8056
8057 case R_PPC_TPREL32:
8058 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8059 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
8060 goto dodyn;
8061
8062 case R_PPC_DTPREL32:
8063 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8064 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
8065 goto dodyn;
8066
8067 case R_PPC_DTPMOD32:
8068 relocation = 1;
8069 addend = 0;
8070 goto dodyn;
8071
8072 case R_PPC_REL16:
8073 case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
8074 case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
8075 case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
8076 case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
8077 break;
8078
8079 case R_PPC_REL32:
8080 if (h == NULL || h == htab->elf.hgot)
8081 break;
8082 /* fall through */
8083
8084 case R_PPC_ADDR32:
8085 case R_PPC_ADDR16:
8086 case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
8087 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HI:
8088 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
8089 case R_PPC_UADDR32:
8090 case R_PPC_UADDR16:
8091 goto dodyn;
8092
8093 case R_PPC_VLE_REL8:
8094 case R_PPC_VLE_REL15:
8095 case R_PPC_VLE_REL24:
8096 case R_PPC_REL24:
8097 case R_PPC_REL14:
8098 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
8099 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
8100 /* If these relocations are not to a named symbol, they can be
8101 handled right here, no need to bother the dynamic linker. */
8102 if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
8103 || h == htab->elf.hgot)
8104 break;
8105 /* fall through */
8106
8107 case R_PPC_ADDR24:
8108 case R_PPC_ADDR14:
8109 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
8110 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
8111 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
8112 break;
8113 /* fall through */
8114
8115 dodyn:
8116 if ((input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
8117 || is_vxworks_tls)
8118 break;
8119
8120 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
8121 ? ((h == NULL
8122 || ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs != NULL)
8123 && ((h != NULL && pc_dynrelocs (h))
8124 || must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)))
8125 : (h != NULL
8126 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs != NULL))
8127 {
8128 int skip;
8129 bfd_byte *loc;
8130 asection *sreloc;
8131 long indx = 0;
8132
8133 #ifdef DEBUG
8134 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_relocate_section needs to "
8135 "create relocation for %s\n",
8136 (h && h->root.root.string
8137 ? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"));
8138 #endif
8139
8140 /* When generating a shared object, these relocations
8141 are copied into the output file to be resolved at run
8142 time. */
8143 skip = 0;
8144 outrel.r_offset = _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info,
8145 input_section,
8146 rel->r_offset);
8147 if (outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -1
8148 || outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -2)
8149 skip = (int) outrel.r_offset;
8150 outrel.r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
8151 + input_section->output_offset);
8152
8153 if (skip)
8154 memset (&outrel, 0, sizeof outrel);
8155 else if (!SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
8156 {
8157 indx = h->dynindx;
8158 BFD_ASSERT (indx != -1);
8159 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8160 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
8161 outrel.r_addend = rel->r_addend;
8162 }
8163 else
8164 {
8165 outrel.r_addend = relocation + rel->r_addend;
8166
8167 if (r_type != R_PPC_ADDR32)
8168 {
8169 if (ifunc != NULL)
8170 {
8171 /* If we get here when building a static
8172 executable, then the libc startup function
8173 responsible for applying indirect function
8174 relocations is going to complain about
8175 the reloc type.
8176 If we get here when building a dynamic
8177 executable, it will be because we have
8178 a text relocation. The dynamic loader
8179 will set the text segment writable and
8180 non-executable to apply text relocations.
8181 So we'll segfault when trying to run the
8182 indirection function to resolve the reloc. */
8183 info->callbacks->einfo
8184 /* xgettext:c-format */
8185 (_("%H: relocation %s for indirect "
8186 "function %s unsupported\n"),
8187 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8188 howto->name,
8189 sym_name);
8190 ret = FALSE;
8191 }
8192 else if (r_symndx == STN_UNDEF || bfd_is_abs_section (sec))
8193 ;
8194 else if (sec == NULL || sec->owner == NULL)
8195 {
8196 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8197 ret = FALSE;
8198 }
8199 else
8200 {
8201 asection *osec;
8202
8203 /* We are turning this relocation into one
8204 against a section symbol. It would be
8205 proper to subtract the symbol's value,
8206 osec->vma, from the emitted reloc addend,
8207 but ld.so expects buggy relocs.
8208 FIXME: Why not always use a zero index? */
8209 osec = sec->output_section;
8210 if ((osec->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
8211 {
8212 osec = htab->elf.tls_sec;
8213 indx = 0;
8214 }
8215 else
8216 {
8217 indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
8218 if (indx == 0)
8219 {
8220 osec = htab->elf.text_index_section;
8221 indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
8222 }
8223 BFD_ASSERT (indx != 0);
8224 }
8225
8226 /* ld.so doesn't expect buggy TLS relocs.
8227 Don't leave the symbol value in the
8228 addend for them. */
8229 if (IS_PPC_TLS_RELOC (r_type))
8230 outrel.r_addend -= osec->vma;
8231 }
8232
8233 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
8234 }
8235 else if (ifunc != NULL)
8236 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
8237 else
8238 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
8239 }
8240
8241 sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
8242 if (ifunc)
8243 {
8244 sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
8245 if (indx == 0)
8246 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
8247 else if (is_static_defined (h))
8248 htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
8249 }
8250 if (sreloc == NULL)
8251 return FALSE;
8252
8253 loc = sreloc->contents;
8254 loc += sreloc->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8255 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
8256
8257 if (skip == -1)
8258 goto copy_reloc;
8259
8260 /* This reloc will be computed at runtime. Clear the memory
8261 so that it contains a predictable value for prelink. */
8262 if (!skip)
8263 {
8264 relocation = howto->pc_relative ? outrel.r_offset : 0;
8265 addend = 0;
8266 break;
8267 }
8268 }
8269 break;
8270
8271 case R_PPC_RELAX_PLT:
8272 case R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24:
8273 if (h != NULL)
8274 {
8275 struct plt_entry *ent;
8276 bfd_vma got2_addend = 0;
8277
8278 if (r_type == R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24)
8279 {
8280 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8281 got2_addend = addend;
8282 addend = 0;
8283 }
8284 ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist, got2, got2_addend);
8285 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
8286 relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
8287 + htab->glink->output_offset
8288 + ent->glink_offset);
8289 else
8290 relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
8291 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
8292 + ent->plt.offset);
8293 }
8294 /* Fall through. */
8295
8296 case R_PPC_RELAX:
8297 {
8298 const int *stub;
8299 size_t size;
8300 size_t insn_offset = rel->r_offset;
8301 unsigned int insn;
8302
8303 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8304 {
8305 relocation -= (input_section->output_section->vma
8306 + input_section->output_offset
8307 + rel->r_offset - 4);
8308 stub = shared_stub_entry;
8309 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[0], contents + insn_offset - 12);
8310 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[1], contents + insn_offset - 8);
8311 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[2], contents + insn_offset - 4);
8312 stub += 3;
8313 size = ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry) - 3;
8314 }
8315 else
8316 {
8317 stub = stub_entry;
8318 size = ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry);
8319 }
8320
8321 relocation += addend;
8322 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
8323 relocation = 0;
8324
8325 /* First insn is HA, second is LO. */
8326 insn = *stub++;
8327 insn |= ((relocation + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
8328 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8329 insn_offset += 4;
8330
8331 insn = *stub++;
8332 insn |= relocation & 0xffff;
8333 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8334 insn_offset += 4;
8335 size -= 2;
8336
8337 while (size != 0)
8338 {
8339 insn = *stub++;
8340 --size;
8341 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8342 insn_offset += 4;
8343 }
8344
8345 /* Rewrite the reloc and convert one of the trailing nop
8346 relocs to describe this relocation. */
8347 BFD_ASSERT (ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_NONE);
8348 /* The relocs are at the bottom 2 bytes */
8349 wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset + d_offset;
8350 wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
8351 wrel->r_addend = rel->r_addend;
8352 memmove (wrel + 1, wrel, (relend - wrel - 1) * sizeof (*wrel));
8353 wrel++, rel++;
8354 wrel->r_offset += 4;
8355 wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
8356 }
8357 continue;
8358
8359 /* Indirect .sdata relocation. */
8360 case R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:
8361 BFD_ASSERT (htab->sdata[0].section != NULL);
8362 if (!is_static_defined (htab->sdata[0].sym))
8363 {
8364 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8365 break;
8366 }
8367 relocation
8368 = elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (input_bfd, &htab->sdata[0],
8369 h, relocation, rel);
8370 addend = 0;
8371 break;
8372
8373 /* Indirect .sdata2 relocation. */
8374 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:
8375 BFD_ASSERT (htab->sdata[1].section != NULL);
8376 if (!is_static_defined (htab->sdata[1].sym))
8377 {
8378 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8379 break;
8380 }
8381 relocation
8382 = elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (input_bfd, &htab->sdata[1],
8383 h, relocation, rel);
8384 addend = 0;
8385 break;
8386
8387 /* Handle the TOC16 reloc. We want to use the offset within the .got
8388 section, not the actual VMA. This is appropriate when generating
8389 an embedded ELF object, for which the .got section acts like the
8390 AIX .toc section. */
8391 case R_PPC_TOC16: /* phony GOT16 relocations */
8392 if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8393 {
8394 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8395 break;
8396 }
8397 BFD_ASSERT (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (sec->owner, sec),
8398 ".got") == 0
8399 || strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (sec->owner, sec),
8400 ".cgot") == 0);
8401
8402 addend -= sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset + 0x8000;
8403 break;
8404
8405 case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
8406 if (h != NULL && ifunc == NULL)
8407 {
8408 struct plt_entry *ent;
8409
8410 ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist, got2,
8411 bfd_link_pic (info) ? addend : 0);
8412 if (ent == NULL
8413 || htab->elf.splt == NULL)
8414 {
8415 /* We didn't make a PLT entry for this symbol. This
8416 happens when statically linking PIC code, or when
8417 using -Bsymbolic. */
8418 }
8419 else
8420 {
8421 /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the
8422 procedure linkage table. */
8423 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8424 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
8425 relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
8426 + htab->glink->output_offset
8427 + ent->glink_offset);
8428 else
8429 relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
8430 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
8431 + ent->plt.offset);
8432 }
8433 }
8434
8435 /* R_PPC_PLTREL24 is rather special. If non-zero, the
8436 addend specifies the GOT pointer offset within .got2.
8437 Don't apply it to the relocation field. */
8438 addend = 0;
8439 break;
8440
8441 case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
8442 case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
8443 case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
8444 case R_PPC_PLT16_HI:
8445 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8446 plt_list = NULL;
8447 if (h != NULL)
8448 plt_list = &h->plt.plist;
8449 else if (ifunc != NULL)
8450 plt_list = ifunc;
8451 else if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
8452 {
8453 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
8454 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets
8455 + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
8456 plt_list = local_plt + r_symndx;
8457 }
8458 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8459 if (plt_list != NULL)
8460 {
8461 struct plt_entry *ent;
8462
8463 ent = find_plt_ent (plt_list, got2,
8464 bfd_link_pic (info) ? addend : 0);
8465 if (ent != NULL && ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
8466 {
8467 asection *plt;
8468
8469 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8470 plt = htab->elf.splt;
8471 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
8472 || h == NULL
8473 || h->dynindx == -1)
8474 {
8475 if (ifunc != NULL)
8476 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
8477 else
8478 plt = htab->pltlocal;
8479 }
8480 relocation = (plt->output_section->vma
8481 + plt->output_offset
8482 + ent->plt.offset);
8483 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8484 {
8485 bfd_vma got = 0;
8486
8487 if (ent->addend >= 32768)
8488 got = (ent->addend
8489 + ent->sec->output_section->vma
8490 + ent->sec->output_offset);
8491 else
8492 got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
8493 relocation -= got;
8494 }
8495 }
8496 }
8497 addend = 0;
8498 break;
8499
8500 /* Relocate against _SDA_BASE_. */
8501 case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
8502 {
8503 const char *name;
8504 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8505
8506 if (sec == NULL
8507 || sec->output_section == NULL
8508 || !is_static_defined (sda))
8509 {
8510 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8511 break;
8512 }
8513 addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8514
8515 name = bfd_get_section_name (output_bfd, sec->output_section);
8516 if (!(strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8517 || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0))
8518 {
8519 _bfd_error_handler
8520 /* xgettext:c-format */
8521 (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8522 "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8523 input_bfd,
8524 sym_name,
8525 howto->name,
8526 name);
8527 }
8528 }
8529 break;
8530
8531 /* Relocate against _SDA2_BASE_. */
8532 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:
8533 {
8534 const char *name;
8535 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8536
8537 if (sec == NULL
8538 || sec->output_section == NULL
8539 || !is_static_defined (sda))
8540 {
8541 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8542 break;
8543 }
8544 addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8545
8546 name = bfd_get_section_name (output_bfd, sec->output_section);
8547 if (!(strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8548 || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0))
8549 {
8550 _bfd_error_handler
8551 /* xgettext:c-format */
8552 (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8553 "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8554 input_bfd,
8555 sym_name,
8556 howto->name,
8557 name);
8558 }
8559 }
8560 break;
8561
8562 case R_PPC_VLE_LO16A:
8563 relocation = relocation + addend;
8564 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8565 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8566 split16a_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8567 goto copy_reloc;
8568
8569 case R_PPC_VLE_LO16D:
8570 relocation = relocation + addend;
8571 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8572 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8573 split16d_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8574 goto copy_reloc;
8575
8576 case R_PPC_VLE_HI16A:
8577 relocation = (relocation + addend) >> 16;
8578 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8579 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8580 split16a_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8581 goto copy_reloc;
8582
8583 case R_PPC_VLE_HI16D:
8584 relocation = (relocation + addend) >> 16;
8585 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8586 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8587 split16d_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8588 goto copy_reloc;
8589
8590 case R_PPC_VLE_HA16A:
8591 relocation = (relocation + addend + 0x8000) >> 16;
8592 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8593 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8594 split16a_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8595 goto copy_reloc;
8596
8597 case R_PPC_VLE_HA16D:
8598 relocation = (relocation + addend + 0x8000) >> 16;
8599 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8600 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8601 split16d_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8602 goto copy_reloc;
8603
8604 /* Relocate against either _SDA_BASE_, _SDA2_BASE_, or 0. */
8605 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA21:
8606 case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21:
8607 case R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:
8608 case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:
8609 {
8610 const char *name;
8611 int reg;
8612 unsigned int insn;
8613 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = NULL;
8614
8615 if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8616 {
8617 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8618 break;
8619 }
8620
8621 name = bfd_get_section_name (output_bfd, sec->output_section);
8622 if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8623 || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
8624 {
8625 reg = 13;
8626 sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8627 }
8628 else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8629 || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0)
8630 {
8631 reg = 2;
8632 sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8633 }
8634 else if (strcmp (name, ".PPC.EMB.sdata0") == 0
8635 || strcmp (name, ".PPC.EMB.sbss0") == 0)
8636 {
8637 reg = 0;
8638 }
8639 else
8640 {
8641 _bfd_error_handler
8642 /* xgettext:c-format */
8643 (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8644 "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8645 input_bfd,
8646 sym_name,
8647 howto->name,
8648 name);
8649
8650 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8651 ret = FALSE;
8652 goto copy_reloc;
8653 }
8654
8655 if (sda != NULL)
8656 {
8657 if (!is_static_defined (sda))
8658 {
8659 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8660 break;
8661 }
8662 addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8663 }
8664
8665 if (r_type == R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA)
8666 break;
8667
8668 /* The PowerPC Embedded Application Binary Interface
8669 version 1.0 insanely chose to specify R_PPC_EMB_SDA21
8670 operating on a 24-bit field at r_offset. GNU as and
8671 GNU ld have always assumed R_PPC_EMB_SDA21 operates on
8672 a 32-bit bit insn at r_offset. Cope with object file
8673 producers that possibly comply with the EABI in
8674 generating an odd r_offset for big-endian objects. */
8675 if (r_type == R_PPC_EMB_SDA21)
8676 rel->r_offset &= ~1;
8677
8678 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
8679 if (reg == 0
8680 && (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21
8681 || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO))
8682 {
8683 relocation = relocation + addend;
8684 addend = 0;
8685
8686 /* Force e_li insn, keeping RT from original insn. */
8687 insn &= 0x1f << 21;
8688 insn |= 28u << 26;
8689
8690 /* We have an li20 field, bits 17..20, 11..15, 21..31. */
8691 /* Top 4 bits of value to 17..20. */
8692 insn |= (relocation & 0xf0000) >> 5;
8693 /* Next 5 bits of the value to 11..15. */
8694 insn |= (relocation & 0xf800) << 5;
8695 /* And the final 11 bits of the value to bits 21 to 31. */
8696 insn |= relocation & 0x7ff;
8697
8698 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
8699
8700 if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21
8701 && ((relocation + 0x80000) & 0xffffffff) > 0x100000)
8702 goto overflow;
8703 goto copy_reloc;
8704 }
8705 /* Fill in register field. */
8706 insn = (insn & ~RA_REGISTER_MASK) | (reg << RA_REGISTER_SHIFT);
8707 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
8708 }
8709 break;
8710
8711 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
8712 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
8713 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
8714 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
8715 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
8716 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
8717 {
8718 bfd_vma value;
8719 const char *name;
8720 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = NULL;
8721
8722 if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8723 {
8724 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8725 break;
8726 }
8727
8728 name = bfd_get_section_name (output_bfd, sec->output_section);
8729 if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8730 || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
8731 sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8732 else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8733 || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0)
8734 sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8735 else
8736 {
8737 _bfd_error_handler
8738 /* xgettext:c-format */
8739 (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8740 "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8741 input_bfd,
8742 sym_name,
8743 howto->name,
8744 name);
8745
8746 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8747 ret = FALSE;
8748 goto copy_reloc;
8749 }
8750
8751 if (sda == NULL || !is_static_defined (sda))
8752 {
8753 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8754 break;
8755 }
8756 value = relocation + addend - SYM_VAL (sda);
8757
8758 if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A)
8759 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8760 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8761 split16a_type,
8762 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8763 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D)
8764 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8765 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8766 split16d_type,
8767 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8768 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A)
8769 {
8770 value = value >> 16;
8771 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8772 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8773 split16a_type,
8774 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8775 }
8776 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D)
8777 {
8778 value = value >> 16;
8779 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8780 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8781 split16d_type,
8782 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8783 }
8784 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A)
8785 {
8786 value = (value + 0x8000) >> 16;
8787 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8788 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8789 split16a_type,
8790 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8791 }
8792 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D)
8793 {
8794 value = (value + 0x8000) >> 16;
8795 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8796 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8797 split16d_type,
8798 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8799 }
8800 }
8801 goto copy_reloc;
8802
8803 case R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20:
8804 ppc_elf_vle_split20 (output_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset, relocation);
8805 continue;
8806
8807 /* Relocate against the beginning of the section. */
8808 case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
8809 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
8810 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI:
8811 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
8812 if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8813 {
8814 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8815 break;
8816 }
8817 addend -= sec->output_section->vma;
8818 break;
8819
8820 /* Negative relocations. */
8821 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:
8822 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:
8823 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:
8824 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:
8825 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
8826 addend -= 2 * relocation;
8827 break;
8828
8829 case R_PPC_COPY:
8830 case R_PPC_GLOB_DAT:
8831 case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
8832 case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
8833 case R_PPC_IRELATIVE:
8834 case R_PPC_PLT32:
8835 case R_PPC_PLTREL32:
8836 case R_PPC_ADDR30:
8837 case R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:
8838 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:
8839 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:
8840 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
8841 case R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:
8842 /* xgettext:c-format */
8843 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
8844 input_bfd, howto->name);
8845
8846 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8847 ret = FALSE;
8848 goto copy_reloc;
8849 }
8850
8851 switch (r_type)
8852 {
8853 default:
8854 break;
8855
8856 case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
8857 if (unresolved_reloc)
8858 {
8859 bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset;
8860 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
8861 insn &= 1;
8862 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | insn, p);
8863 unresolved_reloc = save_unresolved_reloc;
8864 r_type = R_PPC_REL24;
8865 howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
8866 }
8867 else if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
8868 info->callbacks->einfo
8869 (_("%X%P: %H: %s relocation unsupported for bss-plt\n"),
8870 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8871 howto->name);
8872 break;
8873
8874 case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
8875 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8876 case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
8877 if (unresolved_reloc)
8878 {
8879 bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
8880 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
8881 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8882 r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
8883 howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
8884 }
8885 else if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
8886 info->callbacks->einfo
8887 (_("%X%P: %H: %s relocation unsupported for bss-plt\n"),
8888 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8889 howto->name);
8890 break;
8891 }
8892
8893 /* Do any further special processing. */
8894 switch (r_type)
8895 {
8896 default:
8897 break;
8898
8899 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
8900 case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
8901 case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
8902 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
8903 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
8904 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
8905 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
8906 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
8907 /* It's just possible that this symbol is a weak symbol
8908 that's not actually defined anywhere. In that case,
8909 'sec' would be NULL, and we should leave the symbol
8910 alone (it will be set to zero elsewhere in the link). */
8911 if (sec == NULL)
8912 break;
8913 /* Fall through. */
8914
8915 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8916 case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
8917 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
8918 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
8919 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
8920 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
8921 /* Add 0x10000 if sign bit in 0:15 is set.
8922 Bits 0:15 are not used. */
8923 addend += 0x8000;
8924 break;
8925
8926 case R_PPC_ADDR16:
8927 case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
8928 case R_PPC_GOT16:
8929 case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
8930 case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
8931 case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
8932 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
8933 case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
8934 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
8935 case R_PPC_TPREL16:
8936 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
8937 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
8938 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
8939 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
8940 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
8941 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
8942 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
8943 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
8944 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
8945 {
8946 /* The 32-bit ABI lacks proper relocations to deal with
8947 certain 64-bit instructions. Prevent damage to bits
8948 that make up part of the insn opcode. */
8949 unsigned int insn, mask, lobit;
8950
8951 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
8952 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
8953 mask = 0;
8954 if (is_insn_ds_form (insn))
8955 mask = 3;
8956 else if (is_insn_dq_form (insn))
8957 mask = 15;
8958 else
8959 break;
8960 relocation += addend;
8961 addend = insn & mask;
8962 lobit = mask & relocation;
8963 if (lobit != 0)
8964 {
8965 relocation ^= lobit;
8966 info->callbacks->einfo
8967 /* xgettext:c-format */
8968 (_("%H: error: %s against `%s' not a multiple of %u\n"),
8969 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8970 howto->name, sym_name, mask + 1);
8971 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8972 ret = FALSE;
8973 }
8974 }
8975 break;
8976 }
8977
8978 #ifdef DEBUG
8979 fprintf (stderr, "\ttype = %s (%d), name = %s, symbol index = %ld, "
8980 "offset = %ld, addend = %ld\n",
8981 howto->name,
8982 (int) r_type,
8983 sym_name,
8984 r_symndx,
8985 (long) rel->r_offset,
8986 (long) addend);
8987 #endif
8988
8989 if (unresolved_reloc
8990 && !((input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0
8991 && h->def_dynamic)
8992 && _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section,
8993 rel->r_offset) != (bfd_vma) -1)
8994 {
8995 info->callbacks->einfo
8996 /* xgettext:c-format */
8997 (_("%H: unresolvable %s relocation against symbol `%s'\n"),
8998 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8999 howto->name,
9000 sym_name);
9001 ret = FALSE;
9002 }
9003
9004 /* 16-bit fields in insns mostly have signed values, but a
9005 few insns have 16-bit unsigned values. Really, we should
9006 have different reloc types. */
9007 if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain_overflow_dont
9008 && howto->dst_mask == 0xffff
9009 && (input_section->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
9010 {
9011 enum complain_overflow complain = complain_overflow_signed;
9012
9013 if ((elf_section_flags (input_section) & SHF_PPC_VLE) == 0)
9014 {
9015 unsigned int insn;
9016
9017 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
9018 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 10u << 26 /* cmpli */)
9019 complain = complain_overflow_bitfield;
9020 else if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi */
9021 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori */
9022 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori */)
9023 complain = complain_overflow_unsigned;
9024 }
9025 if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain)
9026 {
9027 alt_howto = *howto;
9028 alt_howto.complain_on_overflow = complain;
9029 howto = &alt_howto;
9030 }
9031 }
9032
9033 if (r_type == R_PPC_REL16DX_HA)
9034 {
9035 /* Split field reloc isn't handled by _bfd_final_link_relocate. */
9036 if (rel->r_offset + 4 > input_section->size)
9037 r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
9038 else
9039 {
9040 unsigned int insn;
9041
9042 relocation += addend;
9043 relocation -= (rel->r_offset
9044 + input_section->output_offset
9045 + input_section->output_section->vma);
9046 relocation >>= 16;
9047 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
9048 insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
9049 insn |= (relocation & 0xffc1) | ((relocation & 0x3e) << 15);
9050 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
9051 r = bfd_reloc_ok;
9052 }
9053 }
9054 else
9055 r = _bfd_final_link_relocate (howto, input_bfd, input_section, contents,
9056 rel->r_offset, relocation, addend);
9057
9058 if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
9059 {
9060 if (r == bfd_reloc_overflow)
9061 {
9062 overflow:
9063 /* On code like "if (foo) foo();" don't report overflow
9064 on a branch to zero when foo is undefined. */
9065 if (!warned
9066 && !(h != NULL
9067 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
9068 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
9069 && is_branch_reloc (r_type)))
9070 info->callbacks->reloc_overflow
9071 (info, (h ? &h->root : NULL), sym_name, howto->name,
9072 rel->r_addend, input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
9073 }
9074 else
9075 {
9076 info->callbacks->einfo
9077 /* xgettext:c-format */
9078 (_("%H: %s reloc against `%s': error %d\n"),
9079 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
9080 howto->name, sym_name, (int) r);
9081 ret = FALSE;
9082 }
9083 }
9084 copy_reloc:
9085 if (wrel != rel)
9086 *wrel = *rel;
9087 }
9088
9089 if (wrel != rel)
9090 {
9091 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
9092 size_t deleted = rel - wrel;
9093
9094 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section->output_section);
9095 rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
9096 if (rel_hdr->sh_size == 0)
9097 {
9098 /* It is too late to remove an empty reloc section. Leave
9099 one NONE reloc.
9100 ??? What is wrong with an empty section??? */
9101 rel_hdr->sh_size = rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
9102 deleted -= 1;
9103 wrel++;
9104 }
9105 relend = wrel;
9106 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section);
9107 rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
9108 input_section->reloc_count -= deleted;
9109 }
9110
9111 #ifdef DEBUG
9112 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9113 #endif
9114
9115 if (input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET
9116 && input_section->size != input_section->rawsize
9117 && (strcmp (input_section->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
9118 || strcmp (input_section->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0))
9119 {
9120 /* Branch around the trampolines. */
9121 unsigned int insn = B + input_section->size - input_section->rawsize;
9122 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + input_section->rawsize);
9123 }
9124
9125 if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
9126 && input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET
9127 && (!bfd_link_relocatable (info)
9128 || (input_section->output_section->alignment_power
9129 >= htab->params->pagesize_p2)))
9130 {
9131 bfd_vma start_addr, end_addr, addr;
9132 bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
9133
9134 if (relax_info->workaround_size != 0)
9135 {
9136 bfd_byte *p;
9137 unsigned int n;
9138 bfd_byte fill[4];
9139
9140 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, BA, fill);
9141 p = contents + input_section->size - relax_info->workaround_size;
9142 n = relax_info->workaround_size >> 2;
9143 while (n--)
9144 {
9145 memcpy (p, fill, 4);
9146 p += 4;
9147 }
9148 }
9149
9150 /* The idea is: Replace the last instruction on a page with a
9151 branch to a patch area. Put the insn there followed by a
9152 branch back to the next page. Complicated a little by
9153 needing to handle moved conditional branches, and by not
9154 wanting to touch data-in-text. */
9155
9156 start_addr = (input_section->output_section->vma
9157 + input_section->output_offset);
9158 end_addr = (start_addr + input_section->size
9159 - relax_info->workaround_size);
9160 for (addr = ((start_addr & -pagesize) + pagesize - 4);
9161 addr < end_addr;
9162 addr += pagesize)
9163 {
9164 bfd_vma offset = addr - start_addr;
9165 Elf_Internal_Rela *lo, *hi;
9166 bfd_boolean is_data;
9167 bfd_vma patch_off, patch_addr;
9168 unsigned int insn;
9169
9170 /* Do we have a data reloc at this offset? If so, leave
9171 the word alone. */
9172 is_data = FALSE;
9173 lo = relocs;
9174 hi = relend;
9175 rel = NULL;
9176 while (lo < hi)
9177 {
9178 rel = lo + (hi - lo) / 2;
9179 if (rel->r_offset < offset)
9180 lo = rel + 1;
9181 else if (rel->r_offset > offset + 3)
9182 hi = rel;
9183 else
9184 {
9185 switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
9186 {
9187 case R_PPC_ADDR32:
9188 case R_PPC_UADDR32:
9189 case R_PPC_REL32:
9190 case R_PPC_ADDR30:
9191 is_data = TRUE;
9192 break;
9193 default:
9194 break;
9195 }
9196 break;
9197 }
9198 }
9199 if (is_data)
9200 continue;
9201
9202 /* Some instructions can be left alone too. Unconditional
9203 branches, except for bcctr with BO=0x14 (bctr, bctrl),
9204 avoid the icache failure.
9205
9206 The problem occurs due to prefetch across a page boundary
9207 where stale instructions can be fetched from the next
9208 page, and the mechanism for flushing these bad
9209 instructions fails under certain circumstances. The
9210 unconditional branches:
9211 1) Branch: b, bl, ba, bla,
9212 2) Branch Conditional: bc, bca, bcl, bcla,
9213 3) Branch Conditional to Link Register: bclr, bclrl,
9214 where (2) and (3) have BO=0x14 making them unconditional,
9215 prevent the bad prefetch because the prefetch itself is
9216 affected by these instructions. This happens even if the
9217 instruction is not executed.
9218
9219 A bctr example:
9220 .
9221 . lis 9,new_page@ha
9222 . addi 9,9,new_page@l
9223 . mtctr 9
9224 . bctr
9225 . nop
9226 . nop
9227 . new_page:
9228 .
9229 The bctr is not predicted taken due to ctr not being
9230 ready, so prefetch continues on past the bctr into the
9231 new page which might have stale instructions. If they
9232 fail to be flushed, then they will be executed after the
9233 bctr executes. Either of the following modifications
9234 prevent the bad prefetch from happening in the first
9235 place:
9236 .
9237 . lis 9,new_page@ha lis 9,new_page@ha
9238 . addi 9,9,new_page@l addi 9,9,new_page@l
9239 . mtctr 9 mtctr 9
9240 . bctr bctr
9241 . nop b somewhere_else
9242 . b somewhere_else nop
9243 . new_page: new_page:
9244 . */
9245 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset);
9246 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (18u << 26) /* b,bl,ba,bla */
9247 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (16u << 26) /* bc,bcl,bca,bcla*/
9248 && (insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x14 << 21)) /* with BO=0x14 */
9249 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (19u << 26)
9250 && (insn & (0x3ff << 1)) == (16u << 1) /* bclr,bclrl */
9251 && (insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x14 << 21)))/* with BO=0x14 */
9252 continue;
9253
9254 patch_addr = (start_addr + input_section->size
9255 - relax_info->workaround_size);
9256 patch_addr = (patch_addr + 15) & -16;
9257 patch_off = patch_addr - start_addr;
9258 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B + patch_off - offset, contents + offset);
9259
9260 if (rel != NULL
9261 && rel->r_offset >= offset
9262 && rel->r_offset < offset + 4)
9263 {
9264 asection *sreloc;
9265
9266 /* If the insn we are patching had a reloc, adjust the
9267 reloc r_offset so that the reloc applies to the moved
9268 location. This matters for -r and --emit-relocs. */
9269 if (rel + 1 != relend)
9270 {
9271 Elf_Internal_Rela tmp = *rel;
9272
9273 /* Keep the relocs sorted by r_offset. */
9274 memmove (rel, rel + 1, (relend - (rel + 1)) * sizeof (*rel));
9275 relend[-1] = tmp;
9276 }
9277 relend[-1].r_offset += patch_off - offset;
9278
9279 /* Adjust REL16 addends too. */
9280 switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info))
9281 {
9282 case R_PPC_REL16:
9283 case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
9284 case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
9285 case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
9286 relend[-1].r_addend += patch_off - offset;
9287 break;
9288 default:
9289 break;
9290 }
9291
9292 /* If we are building a PIE or shared library with
9293 non-PIC objects, perhaps we had a dynamic reloc too?
9294 If so, the dynamic reloc must move with the insn. */
9295 sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
9296 if (sreloc != NULL)
9297 {
9298 Elf32_External_Rela *slo, *shi, *srelend;
9299 bfd_vma soffset;
9300
9301 slo = (Elf32_External_Rela *) sreloc->contents;
9302 shi = srelend = slo + sreloc->reloc_count;
9303 soffset = (offset + input_section->output_section->vma
9304 + input_section->output_offset);
9305 while (slo < shi)
9306 {
9307 Elf32_External_Rela *srel = slo + (shi - slo) / 2;
9308 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, (bfd_byte *) srel,
9309 &outrel);
9310 if (outrel.r_offset < soffset)
9311 slo = srel + 1;
9312 else if (outrel.r_offset > soffset + 3)
9313 shi = srel;
9314 else
9315 {
9316 if (srel + 1 != srelend)
9317 {
9318 memmove (srel, srel + 1,
9319 (srelend - (srel + 1)) * sizeof (*srel));
9320 srel = srelend - 1;
9321 }
9322 outrel.r_offset += patch_off - offset;
9323 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel,
9324 (bfd_byte *) srel);
9325 break;
9326 }
9327 }
9328 }
9329 }
9330 else
9331 rel = NULL;
9332
9333 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (16u << 26) /* bc */
9334 && (insn & 2) == 0 /* relative */)
9335 {
9336 bfd_vma delta = ((insn & 0xfffc) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
9337
9338 delta += offset - patch_off;
9339 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info) && rel != NULL)
9340 delta = 0;
9341 if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info) && rel != NULL)
9342 {
9343 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
9344
9345 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info);
9346 if (r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN)
9347 insn |= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9348 else if (r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
9349 insn &= ~BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9350 else
9351 BFD_ASSERT (r_type == R_PPC_REL14);
9352
9353 if ((r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN
9354 || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
9355 && delta + 0x8000 < 0x10000
9356 && (bfd_signed_vma) delta < 0)
9357 insn ^= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9358 }
9359 if (delta + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
9360 {
9361 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9362 (insn & ~0xfffc) | (delta & 0xfffc),
9363 contents + patch_off);
9364 patch_off += 4;
9365 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9366 B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9367 contents + patch_off);
9368 patch_off += 4;
9369 }
9370 else
9371 {
9372 if (rel != NULL)
9373 {
9374 unsigned int r_sym = ELF32_R_SYM (relend[-1].r_info);
9375
9376 relend[-1].r_offset += 8;
9377 relend[-1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_sym, R_PPC_REL24);
9378 }
9379 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9380 (insn & ~0xfffc) | 8,
9381 contents + patch_off);
9382 patch_off += 4;
9383 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9384 B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9385 contents + patch_off);
9386 patch_off += 4;
9387 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9388 B | ((delta - 8) & 0x3fffffc),
9389 contents + patch_off);
9390 patch_off += 4;
9391 }
9392 }
9393 else
9394 {
9395 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + patch_off);
9396 patch_off += 4;
9397 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9398 B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9399 contents + patch_off);
9400 patch_off += 4;
9401 }
9402 BFD_ASSERT (patch_off <= input_section->size);
9403 relax_info->workaround_size = input_section->size - patch_off;
9404 }
9405 }
9406
9407 return ret;
9408 }
9409 \f
9410 /* Write out the PLT relocs and entries for H. */
9411
9412 static bfd_boolean
9413 write_global_sym_plt (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
9414 {
9415 struct bfd_link_info *info = (struct bfd_link_info *) inf;
9416 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9417 struct plt_entry *ent;
9418 bfd_boolean doneone;
9419
9420 doneone = FALSE;
9421 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9422 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9423 {
9424 if (!doneone)
9425 {
9426 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9427 bfd_byte *loc;
9428 bfd_vma reloc_index;
9429 asection *plt = htab->elf.splt;
9430 asection *relplt = htab->elf.srelplt;
9431
9432 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
9433 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9434 || h->dynindx == -1)
9435 reloc_index = ent->plt.offset / 4;
9436 else
9437 {
9438 reloc_index = ((ent->plt.offset - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
9439 / htab->plt_slot_size);
9440 if (reloc_index > PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES
9441 && htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
9442 reloc_index -= (reloc_index - PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES) / 2;
9443 }
9444
9445 /* This symbol has an entry in the procedure linkage table.
9446 Set it up. */
9447 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS
9448 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9449 && h->dynindx != -1)
9450 {
9451 bfd_vma got_offset;
9452 const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
9453
9454 /* The first three entries in .got.plt are reserved. */
9455 got_offset = (reloc_index + 3) * 4;
9456
9457 /* Use the right PLT. */
9458 plt_entry = bfd_link_pic (info) ? ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt_entry
9459 : ppc_elf_vxworks_plt_entry;
9460
9461 /* Fill in the .plt on VxWorks. */
9462 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
9463 {
9464 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9465 plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_offset),
9466 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 0);
9467 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9468 plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_offset),
9469 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 4);
9470 }
9471 else
9472 {
9473 bfd_vma got_loc = got_offset + SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
9474
9475 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9476 plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_loc),
9477 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 0);
9478 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9479 plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_loc),
9480 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 4);
9481 }
9482
9483 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[2],
9484 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 8);
9485 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[3],
9486 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 12);
9487
9488 /* This instruction is an immediate load. The value loaded is
9489 the byte offset of the R_PPC_JMP_SLOT relocation from the
9490 start of the .rela.plt section. The value is stored in the
9491 low-order 16 bits of the load instruction. */
9492 /* NOTE: It appears that this is now an index rather than a
9493 prescaled offset. */
9494 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9495 plt_entry[4] | reloc_index,
9496 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 16);
9497 /* This instruction is a PC-relative branch whose target is
9498 the start of the PLT section. The address of this branch
9499 instruction is 20 bytes beyond the start of this PLT entry.
9500 The address is encoded in bits 6-29, inclusive. The value
9501 stored is right-shifted by two bits, permitting a 26-bit
9502 offset. */
9503 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9504 (plt_entry[5]
9505 | (-(ent->plt.offset + 20) & 0x03fffffc)),
9506 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 20);
9507 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[6],
9508 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 24);
9509 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[7],
9510 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 28);
9511
9512 /* Fill in the GOT entry corresponding to this PLT slot with
9513 the address immediately after the "bctr" instruction
9514 in this PLT entry. */
9515 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, (plt->output_section->vma
9516 + plt->output_offset
9517 + ent->plt.offset + 16),
9518 htab->elf.sgotplt->contents + got_offset);
9519
9520 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
9521 {
9522 /* Fill in a couple of entries in .rela.plt.unloaded. */
9523 loc = htab->srelplt2->contents
9524 + ((VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS + reloc_index
9525 * VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS)
9526 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9527
9528 /* Provide the @ha relocation for the first instruction. */
9529 rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9530 + plt->output_offset
9531 + ent->plt.offset + 2);
9532 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx,
9533 R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
9534 rela.r_addend = got_offset;
9535 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9536 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9537
9538 /* Provide the @l relocation for the second instruction. */
9539 rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9540 + plt->output_offset
9541 + ent->plt.offset + 6);
9542 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx,
9543 R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
9544 rela.r_addend = got_offset;
9545 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9546 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9547
9548 /* Provide a relocation for the GOT entry corresponding to this
9549 PLT slot. Point it at the middle of the .plt entry. */
9550 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
9551 + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
9552 + got_offset);
9553 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hplt->indx,
9554 R_PPC_ADDR32);
9555 rela.r_addend = ent->plt.offset + 16;
9556 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9557 }
9558
9559 /* VxWorks uses non-standard semantics for R_PPC_JMP_SLOT.
9560 In particular, the offset for the relocation is not the
9561 address of the PLT entry for this function, as specified
9562 by the ABI. Instead, the offset is set to the address of
9563 the GOT slot for this function. See EABI 4.4.4.1. */
9564 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
9565 + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
9566 + got_offset);
9567 rela.r_addend = 0;
9568 }
9569 else
9570 {
9571 rela.r_addend = 0;
9572 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9573 || h->dynindx == -1)
9574 {
9575 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9576 {
9577 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9578 relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
9579 }
9580 else
9581 {
9582 plt = htab->pltlocal;
9583 relplt = bfd_link_pic (info) ? htab->relpltlocal : NULL;
9584 }
9585 if (h->def_regular
9586 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
9587 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
9588 rela.r_addend = SYM_VAL (h);
9589 }
9590
9591 if (relplt == NULL)
9592 {
9593 loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
9594 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, rela.r_addend, loc);
9595 }
9596 else
9597 {
9598 rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9599 + plt->output_offset
9600 + ent->plt.offset);
9601
9602 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD
9603 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9604 || h->dynindx == -1)
9605 {
9606 /* We don't need to fill in the .plt. The ppc dynamic
9607 linker will fill it in. */
9608 }
9609 else
9610 {
9611 bfd_vma val = (htab->glink_pltresolve + ent->plt.offset
9612 + htab->glink->output_section->vma
9613 + htab->glink->output_offset);
9614 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, val,
9615 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset);
9616 }
9617 }
9618 }
9619
9620 if (relplt != NULL)
9621 {
9622 /* Fill in the entry in the .rela.plt section. */
9623 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9624 || h->dynindx == -1)
9625 {
9626 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9627 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
9628 else
9629 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
9630 loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
9631 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9632 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9633 }
9634 else
9635 {
9636 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC_JMP_SLOT);
9637 loc = relplt->contents + (reloc_index
9638 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9639 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && is_static_defined (h))
9640 htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9641 }
9642 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9643 }
9644 doneone = TRUE;
9645 }
9646
9647 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
9648 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9649 || h->dynindx == -1)
9650 {
9651 unsigned char *p;
9652 asection *plt = htab->elf.splt;
9653
9654 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9655 || h->dynindx == -1)
9656 {
9657 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9658 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9659 else
9660 break;
9661 }
9662
9663 p = (unsigned char *) htab->glink->contents + ent->glink_offset;
9664 write_glink_stub (h, ent, plt, p, info);
9665
9666 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
9667 /* We only need one non-PIC glink stub. */
9668 break;
9669 }
9670 else
9671 break;
9672 }
9673 return TRUE;
9674 }
9675
9676 /* Finish up PLT handling. */
9677
9678 bfd_boolean
9679 ppc_finish_symbols (struct bfd_link_info *info)
9680 {
9681 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9682 bfd *ibfd;
9683
9684 if (!htab)
9685 return TRUE;
9686
9687 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, write_global_sym_plt, info);
9688
9689 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
9690 {
9691 bfd_vma *local_got, *end_local_got;
9692 struct plt_entry **local_plt, **lplt, **end_local_plt;
9693 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
9694 bfd_size_type locsymcount;
9695 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms = NULL;
9696 struct plt_entry *ent;
9697
9698 if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
9699 continue;
9700
9701 local_got = elf_local_got_offsets (ibfd);
9702 if (!local_got)
9703 continue;
9704
9705 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
9706 locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
9707 end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount;
9708 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_local_got;
9709 end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
9710 for (lplt = local_plt; lplt < end_local_plt; ++lplt)
9711 for (ent = *lplt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9712 {
9713 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9714 {
9715 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
9716 asection *sym_sec;
9717 asection *plt, *relplt;
9718 bfd_byte *loc;
9719 bfd_vma val;
9720 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9721 unsigned char *p;
9722
9723 if (!get_sym_h (NULL, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
9724 lplt - local_plt, ibfd))
9725 {
9726 if (local_syms != NULL
9727 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
9728 free (local_syms);
9729 return FALSE;
9730 }
9731
9732 val = sym->st_value;
9733 if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
9734 val += sym_sec->output_offset + sym_sec->output_section->vma;
9735
9736 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9737 {
9738 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9739 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9740 relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
9741 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
9742 }
9743 else
9744 {
9745 plt = htab->pltlocal;
9746 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
9747 {
9748 relplt = htab->relpltlocal;
9749 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
9750 }
9751 else
9752 {
9753 loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
9754 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, val, loc);
9755 continue;
9756 }
9757 }
9758
9759 rela.r_offset = (ent->plt.offset
9760 + plt->output_offset
9761 + plt->output_section->vma);
9762 rela.r_addend = val;
9763 loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
9764 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9765 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9766
9767 p = (unsigned char *) htab->glink->contents + ent->glink_offset;
9768 write_glink_stub (NULL, ent, htab->elf.iplt, p, info);
9769 }
9770 }
9771
9772 if (local_syms != NULL
9773 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
9774 {
9775 if (!info->keep_memory)
9776 free (local_syms);
9777 else
9778 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
9779 }
9780 }
9781 return TRUE;
9782 }
9783
9784 /* Finish up dynamic symbol handling. We set the contents of various
9785 dynamic sections here. */
9786
9787 static bfd_boolean
9788 ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
9789 struct bfd_link_info *info,
9790 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
9791 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
9792 {
9793 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9794 struct plt_entry *ent;
9795
9796 #ifdef DEBUG
9797 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol called for %s",
9798 h->root.root.string);
9799 #endif
9800
9801 if (!h->def_regular
9802 || (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && !bfd_link_pic (info)))
9803 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9804 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9805 {
9806 if (!h->def_regular)
9807 {
9808 /* Mark the symbol as undefined, rather than as
9809 defined in the .plt section. Leave the value if
9810 there were any relocations where pointer equality
9811 matters (this is a clue for the dynamic linker, to
9812 make function pointer comparisons work between an
9813 application and shared library), otherwise set it
9814 to zero. */
9815 sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
9816 if (!h->pointer_equality_needed)
9817 sym->st_value = 0;
9818 else if (!h->ref_regular_nonweak)
9819 {
9820 /* This breaks function pointer comparisons, but
9821 that is better than breaking tests for a NULL
9822 function pointer. */
9823 sym->st_value = 0;
9824 }
9825 }
9826 else
9827 {
9828 /* Set the value of ifunc symbols in a non-pie
9829 executable to the glink entry. This is to avoid
9830 text relocations. We can't do this for ifunc in
9831 allocate_dynrelocs, as we do for normal dynamic
9832 function symbols with plt entries, because we need
9833 to keep the original value around for the ifunc
9834 relocation. */
9835 sym->st_shndx
9836 = (_bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
9837 (info->output_bfd, htab->glink->output_section));
9838 sym->st_value = (ent->glink_offset
9839 + htab->glink->output_offset
9840 + htab->glink->output_section->vma);
9841 }
9842 break;
9843 }
9844
9845 if (h->needs_copy)
9846 {
9847 asection *s;
9848 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9849 bfd_byte *loc;
9850
9851 /* This symbols needs a copy reloc. Set it up. */
9852
9853 #ifdef DEBUG
9854 fprintf (stderr, ", copy");
9855 #endif
9856
9857 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
9858
9859 if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
9860 s = htab->relsbss;
9861 else if (h->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro)
9862 s = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
9863 else
9864 s = htab->elf.srelbss;
9865 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
9866
9867 rela.r_offset = SYM_VAL (h);
9868 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC_COPY);
9869 rela.r_addend = 0;
9870 loc = s->contents + s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9871 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9872 }
9873
9874 #ifdef DEBUG
9875 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9876 #endif
9877
9878 return TRUE;
9879 }
9880 \f
9881 static enum elf_reloc_type_class
9882 ppc_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info,
9883 const asection *rel_sec,
9884 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela)
9885 {
9886 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9887
9888 if (rel_sec == htab->elf.irelplt)
9889 return reloc_class_ifunc;
9890
9891 switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rela->r_info))
9892 {
9893 case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
9894 return reloc_class_relative;
9895 case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
9896 return reloc_class_plt;
9897 case R_PPC_COPY:
9898 return reloc_class_copy;
9899 default:
9900 return reloc_class_normal;
9901 }
9902 }
9903 \f
9904 /* Finish up the dynamic sections. */
9905
9906 static bfd_boolean
9907 ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
9908 struct bfd_link_info *info)
9909 {
9910 asection *sdyn;
9911 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9912 bfd_vma got;
9913 bfd *dynobj;
9914 bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
9915
9916 #ifdef DEBUG
9917 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections called\n");
9918 #endif
9919
9920 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9921 dynobj = htab->elf.dynobj;
9922 sdyn = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".dynamic");
9923
9924 got = 0;
9925 if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
9926 got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
9927
9928 if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
9929 {
9930 Elf32_External_Dyn *dyncon, *dynconend;
9931
9932 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.splt != NULL && sdyn != NULL);
9933
9934 dyncon = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) sdyn->contents;
9935 dynconend = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) (sdyn->contents + sdyn->size);
9936 for (; dyncon < dynconend; dyncon++)
9937 {
9938 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
9939 asection *s;
9940
9941 bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_in (dynobj, dyncon, &dyn);
9942
9943 switch (dyn.d_tag)
9944 {
9945 case DT_PLTGOT:
9946 if (htab->is_vxworks)
9947 s = htab->elf.sgotplt;
9948 else
9949 s = htab->elf.splt;
9950 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
9951 break;
9952
9953 case DT_PLTRELSZ:
9954 dyn.d_un.d_val = htab->elf.srelplt->size;
9955 break;
9956
9957 case DT_JMPREL:
9958 s = htab->elf.srelplt;
9959 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
9960 break;
9961
9962 case DT_PPC_GOT:
9963 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = got;
9964 break;
9965
9966 case DT_TEXTREL:
9967 if (htab->local_ifunc_resolver)
9968 info->callbacks->einfo
9969 (_("%X%P: text relocations and GNU indirect "
9970 "functions will result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
9971 else if (htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver)
9972 info->callbacks->einfo
9973 (_("%P: warning: text relocations and GNU indirect "
9974 "functions may result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
9975 continue;
9976
9977 default:
9978 if (htab->is_vxworks
9979 && elf_vxworks_finish_dynamic_entry (output_bfd, &dyn))
9980 break;
9981 continue;
9982 }
9983
9984 bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_out (output_bfd, &dyn, dyncon);
9985 }
9986 }
9987
9988 if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL
9989 && htab->elf.sgot->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
9990 {
9991 if (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sgot
9992 || htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sgotplt)
9993 {
9994 unsigned char *p = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->contents;
9995
9996 p += htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value;
9997 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
9998 {
9999 /* Add a blrl instruction at _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_-4
10000 so that a function can easily find the address of
10001 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
10002 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value - 4
10003 < htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->size);
10004 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, 0x4e800021, p - 4);
10005 }
10006
10007 if (sdyn != NULL)
10008 {
10009 bfd_vma val = sdyn->output_section->vma + sdyn->output_offset;
10010 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value
10011 < htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->size);
10012 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, val, p);
10013 }
10014 }
10015 else
10016 {
10017 /* xgettext:c-format */
10018 _bfd_error_handler (_("%s not defined in linker created %pA"),
10019 htab->elf.hgot->root.root.string,
10020 (htab->elf.sgotplt != NULL
10021 ? htab->elf.sgotplt : htab->elf.sgot));
10022 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
10023 ret = FALSE;
10024 }
10025
10026 elf_section_data (htab->elf.sgot->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize = 4;
10027 }
10028
10029 /* Fill in the first entry in the VxWorks procedure linkage table. */
10030 if (htab->is_vxworks
10031 && htab->elf.splt != NULL
10032 && htab->elf.splt->size != 0
10033 && htab->elf.splt->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
10034 {
10035 asection *splt = htab->elf.splt;
10036 /* Use the right PLT. */
10037 const bfd_vma *plt_entry = (bfd_link_pic (info)
10038 ? ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt0_entry
10039 : ppc_elf_vxworks_plt0_entry);
10040
10041 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
10042 {
10043 bfd_vma got_value = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
10044
10045 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_value),
10046 splt->contents + 0);
10047 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_value),
10048 splt->contents + 4);
10049 }
10050 else
10051 {
10052 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0], splt->contents + 0);
10053 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1], splt->contents + 4);
10054 }
10055 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2], splt->contents + 8);
10056 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], splt->contents + 12);
10057 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], splt->contents + 16);
10058 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], splt->contents + 20);
10059 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[6], splt->contents + 24);
10060 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[7], splt->contents + 28);
10061
10062 if (! bfd_link_pic (info))
10063 {
10064 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
10065 bfd_byte *loc;
10066
10067 loc = htab->srelplt2->contents;
10068
10069 /* Output the @ha relocation for the first instruction. */
10070 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
10071 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
10072 + 2);
10073 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
10074 rela.r_addend = 0;
10075 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
10076 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10077
10078 /* Output the @l relocation for the second instruction. */
10079 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
10080 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
10081 + 6);
10082 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
10083 rela.r_addend = 0;
10084 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
10085 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10086
10087 /* Fix up the remaining relocations. They may have the wrong
10088 symbol index for _G_O_T_ or _P_L_T_ depending on the order
10089 in which symbols were output. */
10090 while (loc < htab->srelplt2->contents + htab->srelplt2->size)
10091 {
10092 Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
10093
10094 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10095 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
10096 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10097 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10098
10099 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10100 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
10101 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10102 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10103
10104 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10105 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hplt->indx, R_PPC_ADDR32);
10106 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10107 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10108 }
10109 }
10110 }
10111
10112 if (htab->glink != NULL
10113 && htab->glink->contents != NULL
10114 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
10115 {
10116 unsigned char *p;
10117 unsigned char *endp;
10118 bfd_vma res0;
10119
10120 /*
10121 * PIC glink code is the following:
10122 *
10123 * # ith PLT code stub.
10124 * addis 11,30,(plt+(i-1)*4-got)@ha
10125 * lwz 11,(plt+(i-1)*4-got)@l(11)
10126 * mtctr 11
10127 * bctr
10128 *
10129 * # A table of branches, one for each plt entry.
10130 * # The idea is that the plt call stub loads ctr and r11 with these
10131 * # addresses, so (r11 - res_0) gives the plt index * 4.
10132 * res_0: b PLTresolve
10133 * res_1: b PLTresolve
10134 * .
10135 * # Some number of entries towards the end can be nops
10136 * res_n_m3: nop
10137 * res_n_m2: nop
10138 * res_n_m1:
10139 *
10140 * PLTresolve:
10141 * addis 11,11,(1f-res_0)@ha
10142 * mflr 0
10143 * bcl 20,31,1f
10144 * 1: addi 11,11,(1b-res_0)@l
10145 * mflr 12
10146 * mtlr 0
10147 * sub 11,11,12 # r11 = index * 4
10148 * addis 12,12,(got+4-1b)@ha
10149 * lwz 0,(got+4-1b)@l(12) # got[1] address of dl_runtime_resolve
10150 * lwz 12,(got+8-1b)@l(12) # got[2] contains the map address
10151 * mtctr 0
10152 * add 0,11,11
10153 * add 11,0,11 # r11 = index * 12 = reloc offset.
10154 * bctr
10155 *
10156 * Non-PIC glink code is a little simpler.
10157 *
10158 * # ith PLT code stub.
10159 * lis 11,(plt+(i-1)*4)@ha
10160 * lwz 11,(plt+(i-1)*4)@l(11)
10161 * mtctr 11
10162 * bctr
10163 *
10164 * The branch table is the same, then comes
10165 *
10166 * PLTresolve:
10167 * lis 12,(got+4)@ha
10168 * addis 11,11,(-res_0)@ha
10169 * lwz 0,(got+4)@l(12) # got[1] address of dl_runtime_resolve
10170 * addi 11,11,(-res_0)@l # r11 = index * 4
10171 * mtctr 0
10172 * add 0,11,11
10173 * lwz 12,(got+8)@l(12) # got[2] contains the map address
10174 * add 11,0,11 # r11 = index * 12 = reloc offset.
10175 * bctr
10176 */
10177
10178 /* Build the branch table, one for each plt entry (less one),
10179 and perhaps some padding. */
10180 p = htab->glink->contents;
10181 p += htab->glink_pltresolve;
10182 endp = htab->glink->contents;
10183 endp += htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
10184 while (p < endp - (htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? 0 : 8 * 4))
10185 {
10186 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B + endp - p, p);
10187 p += 4;
10188 }
10189 while (p < endp)
10190 {
10191 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, p);
10192 p += 4;
10193 }
10194
10195 res0 = (htab->glink_pltresolve
10196 + htab->glink->output_section->vma
10197 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10198
10199 if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround)
10200 {
10201 /* Ensure that a call stub at the end of a page doesn't
10202 result in prefetch over the end of the page into the
10203 glink branch table. */
10204 bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
10205 bfd_vma page_addr;
10206 bfd_vma glink_start = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
10207 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10208
10209 for (page_addr = res0 & -pagesize;
10210 page_addr > glink_start;
10211 page_addr -= pagesize)
10212 {
10213 /* We have a plt call stub that may need fixing. */
10214 bfd_byte *loc;
10215 unsigned int insn;
10216
10217 loc = htab->glink->contents + page_addr - 4 - glink_start;
10218 insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc);
10219 if (insn == BCTR)
10220 {
10221 /* By alignment, we know that there must be at least
10222 one other call stub before this one. */
10223 insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc - 16);
10224 if (insn == BCTR)
10225 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B | (-16 & 0x3fffffc), loc);
10226 else
10227 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B | (-20 & 0x3fffffc), loc);
10228 }
10229 }
10230 }
10231
10232 /* Last comes the PLTresolve stub. */
10233 endp = p + GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
10234 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
10235 {
10236 bfd_vma bcl;
10237
10238 bcl = (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 3*4
10239 + htab->glink->output_section->vma
10240 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10241
10242 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_11 + PPC_HA (bcl - res0), p);
10243 p += 4;
10244 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MFLR_0, p);
10245 p += 4;
10246 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCL_20_31, p);
10247 p += 4;
10248 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDI_11_11 + PPC_LO (bcl - res0), p);
10249 p += 4;
10250 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MFLR_12, p);
10251 p += 4;
10252 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTLR_0, p);
10253 p += 4;
10254 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, SUB_11_11_12, p);
10255 p += 4;
10256 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_12_12 + PPC_HA (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10257 p += 4;
10258 if (PPC_HA (got + 4 - bcl) == PPC_HA (got + 8 - bcl))
10259 {
10260 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10261 p += 4;
10262 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + PPC_LO (got + 8 - bcl), p);
10263 p += 4;
10264 }
10265 else
10266 {
10267 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZU_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10268 p += 4;
10269 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + 4, p);
10270 p += 4;
10271 }
10272 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_0, p);
10273 p += 4;
10274 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_0_11_11, p);
10275 }
10276 else
10277 {
10278 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LIS_12 + PPC_HA (got + 4), p);
10279 p += 4;
10280 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_11 + PPC_HA (-res0), p);
10281 p += 4;
10282 if (PPC_HA (got + 4) == PPC_HA (got + 8))
10283 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4), p);
10284 else
10285 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZU_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4), p);
10286 p += 4;
10287 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDI_11_11 + PPC_LO (-res0), p);
10288 p += 4;
10289 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_0, p);
10290 p += 4;
10291 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_0_11_11, p);
10292 p += 4;
10293 if (PPC_HA (got + 4) == PPC_HA (got + 8))
10294 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + PPC_LO (got + 8), p);
10295 else
10296 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + 4, p);
10297 }
10298 p += 4;
10299 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_11_0_11, p);
10300 p += 4;
10301 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCTR, p);
10302 p += 4;
10303 while (p < endp)
10304 {
10305 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd,
10306 htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? BA : NOP, p);
10307 p += 4;
10308 }
10309 BFD_ASSERT (p == endp);
10310 }
10311
10312 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
10313 && htab->glink_eh_frame->contents != NULL)
10314 {
10315 unsigned char *p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
10316 bfd_vma val;
10317
10318 p += sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
10319 /* FDE length. */
10320 p += 4;
10321 /* CIE pointer. */
10322 p += 4;
10323 /* Offset to .glink. */
10324 val = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
10325 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10326 val -= (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->vma
10327 + htab->glink_eh_frame->output_offset);
10328 val -= p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
10329 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
10330
10331 if (htab->glink_eh_frame->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME
10332 && !_bfd_elf_write_section_eh_frame (output_bfd, info,
10333 htab->glink_eh_frame,
10334 htab->glink_eh_frame->contents))
10335 return FALSE;
10336 }
10337
10338 return ret;
10339 }
10340 \f
10341 #define TARGET_LITTLE_SYM powerpc_elf32_le_vec
10342 #define TARGET_LITTLE_NAME "elf32-powerpcle"
10343 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_vec
10344 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc"
10345 #define ELF_ARCH bfd_arch_powerpc
10346 #define ELF_TARGET_ID PPC32_ELF_DATA
10347 #define ELF_MACHINE_CODE EM_PPC
10348 #define ELF_MAXPAGESIZE 0x10000
10349 #define ELF_COMMONPAGESIZE 0x1000
10350 #define ELF_RELROPAGESIZE ELF_MAXPAGESIZE
10351 #define elf_info_to_howto ppc_elf_info_to_howto
10352
10353 #ifdef EM_CYGNUS_POWERPC
10354 #define ELF_MACHINE_ALT1 EM_CYGNUS_POWERPC
10355 #endif
10356
10357 #ifdef EM_PPC_OLD
10358 #define ELF_MACHINE_ALT2 EM_PPC_OLD
10359 #endif
10360
10361 #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded 1
10362 #define elf_backend_want_dynrelro 1
10363 #define elf_backend_can_gc_sections 1
10364 #define elf_backend_can_refcount 1
10365 #define elf_backend_rela_normal 1
10366 #define elf_backend_caches_rawsize 1
10367
10368 #define bfd_elf32_mkobject ppc_elf_mkobject
10369 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_merge_private_bfd_data ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data
10370 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_relax_section ppc_elf_relax_section
10371 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_type_lookup ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup
10372 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_name_lookup ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup
10373 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_set_private_flags ppc_elf_set_private_flags
10374 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create
10375 #define bfd_elf32_get_synthetic_symtab ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab
10376
10377 #define elf_backend_object_p ppc_elf_object_p
10378 #define elf_backend_gc_mark_hook ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook
10379 #define elf_backend_section_from_shdr ppc_elf_section_from_shdr
10380 #define elf_backend_relocate_section ppc_elf_relocate_section
10381 #define elf_backend_create_dynamic_sections ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections
10382 #define elf_backend_check_relocs ppc_elf_check_relocs
10383 #define elf_backend_relocs_compatible _bfd_elf_relocs_compatible
10384 #define elf_backend_copy_indirect_symbol ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol
10385 #define elf_backend_adjust_dynamic_symbol ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol
10386 #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook
10387 #define elf_backend_size_dynamic_sections ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections
10388 #define elf_backend_hash_symbol ppc_elf_hash_symbol
10389 #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_symbol ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol
10390 #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_sections ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections
10391 #define elf_backend_fake_sections ppc_elf_fake_sections
10392 #define elf_backend_additional_program_headers ppc_elf_additional_program_headers
10393 #define elf_backend_modify_segment_map ppc_elf_modify_segment_map
10394 #define elf_backend_grok_prstatus ppc_elf_grok_prstatus
10395 #define elf_backend_grok_psinfo ppc_elf_grok_psinfo
10396 #define elf_backend_write_core_note ppc_elf_write_core_note
10397 #define elf_backend_reloc_type_class ppc_elf_reloc_type_class
10398 #define elf_backend_begin_write_processing ppc_elf_begin_write_processing
10399 #define elf_backend_final_write_processing ppc_elf_final_write_processing
10400 #define elf_backend_write_section ppc_elf_write_section
10401 #define elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr
10402 #define elf_backend_plt_sym_val ppc_elf_plt_sym_val
10403 #define elf_backend_action_discarded ppc_elf_action_discarded
10404 #define elf_backend_init_index_section _bfd_elf_init_1_index_section
10405 #define elf_backend_lookup_section_flags_hook ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags
10406
10407 #include "elf32-target.h"
10408
10409 /* FreeBSD Target */
10410
10411 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
10412 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
10413
10414 #undef TARGET_BIG_SYM
10415 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_fbsd_vec
10416 #undef TARGET_BIG_NAME
10417 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc-freebsd"
10418
10419 #undef ELF_OSABI
10420 #define ELF_OSABI ELFOSABI_FREEBSD
10421
10422 #undef elf32_bed
10423 #define elf32_bed elf32_powerpc_fbsd_bed
10424
10425 #include "elf32-target.h"
10426
10427 /* VxWorks Target */
10428
10429 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
10430 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
10431
10432 #undef TARGET_BIG_SYM
10433 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_vxworks_vec
10434 #undef TARGET_BIG_NAME
10435 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc-vxworks"
10436
10437 #undef ELF_OSABI
10438
10439 /* VxWorks uses the elf default section flags for .plt. */
10440 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
10441 ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
10442 {
10443 if (sec->name == NULL)
10444 return NULL;
10445
10446 if (strcmp (sec->name, ".plt") == 0)
10447 return _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
10448
10449 return ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
10450 }
10451
10452 /* Like ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create, but overrides
10453 appropriately for VxWorks. */
10454 static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
10455 ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
10456 {
10457 struct bfd_link_hash_table *ret;
10458
10459 ret = ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create (abfd);
10460 if (ret)
10461 {
10462 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab
10463 = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *)ret;
10464 htab->is_vxworks = 1;
10465 htab->plt_type = PLT_VXWORKS;
10466 htab->plt_entry_size = VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
10467 htab->plt_slot_size = VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
10468 htab->plt_initial_entry_size = VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE;
10469 }
10470 return ret;
10471 }
10472
10473 /* Tweak magic VxWorks symbols as they are loaded. */
10474 static bfd_boolean
10475 ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd,
10476 struct bfd_link_info *info,
10477 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
10478 const char **namep,
10479 flagword *flagsp,
10480 asection **secp,
10481 bfd_vma *valp)
10482 {
10483 if (!elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook (abfd, info, sym, namep, flagsp, secp,
10484 valp))
10485 return FALSE;
10486
10487 return ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook (abfd, info, sym, namep, flagsp, secp, valp);
10488 }
10489
10490 static void
10491 ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd, bfd_boolean linker)
10492 {
10493 ppc_elf_final_write_processing (abfd, linker);
10494 elf_vxworks_final_write_processing (abfd, linker);
10495 }
10496
10497 /* On VxWorks, we emit relocations against _PROCEDURE_LINKAGE_TABLE_, so
10498 define it. */
10499 #undef elf_backend_want_plt_sym
10500 #define elf_backend_want_plt_sym 1
10501 #undef elf_backend_want_got_plt
10502 #define elf_backend_want_got_plt 1
10503 #undef elf_backend_got_symbol_offset
10504 #define elf_backend_got_symbol_offset 0
10505 #undef elf_backend_plt_not_loaded
10506 #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded 0
10507 #undef elf_backend_plt_readonly
10508 #define elf_backend_plt_readonly 1
10509 #undef elf_backend_got_header_size
10510 #define elf_backend_got_header_size 12
10511 #undef elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt
10512 #define elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt 1
10513
10514 #undef bfd_elf32_get_synthetic_symtab
10515
10516 #undef bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create
10517 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create \
10518 ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create
10519 #undef elf_backend_add_symbol_hook
10520 #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook \
10521 ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook
10522 #undef elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook
10523 #define elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook \
10524 elf_vxworks_link_output_symbol_hook
10525 #undef elf_backend_final_write_processing
10526 #define elf_backend_final_write_processing \
10527 ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing
10528 #undef elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr
10529 #define elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr \
10530 ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr
10531 #undef elf_backend_emit_relocs
10532 #define elf_backend_emit_relocs \
10533 elf_vxworks_emit_relocs
10534
10535 #undef elf32_bed
10536 #define elf32_bed ppc_elf_vxworks_bed
10537 #undef elf_backend_post_process_headers
10538
10539 #include "elf32-target.h"
This page took 0.262462 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.